Update copyright dates with scripts/update-copyrights.
[glibc.git] / manual / texinfo.tex
blob6d45464eb299c992d91ebd550fbb482faafce163
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2016-09-18.18}
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016
11 % Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
14 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
15 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
16 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
18 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
19 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
20 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
21 % General Public License for more details.
23 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
24 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
26 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
27 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
28 % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
29 % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
34 % http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
35 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % texindex foo.??
48 % tex foo.texi
49 % tex foo.texi
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
62 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
70 % LaTeX's \typeout. This ensures that the messages it is used for
71 % are identical in format to the corresponding ones from latex/pdflatex.
72 \def\typeout{\immediate\write17}%
74 \chardef\other=12
76 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
77 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
78 \let\+ = \relax
80 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
81 \let\ptexb=\b
82 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
83 \let\ptexc=\c
84 \let\ptexcomma=\,
85 \let\ptexdot=\.
86 \let\ptexdots=\dots
87 \let\ptexend=\end
88 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
89 \let\ptexexclam=\!
90 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
91 \let\ptexgtr=>
92 \let\ptexhat=^
93 \let\ptexi=\i
94 \let\ptexindent=\indent
95 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
96 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
97 \let\ptexless=<
98 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
99 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
100 \let\ptexplus=+
101 \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
102 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
103 \let\ptexslash=\/
104 \let\ptexsp=\sp
105 \let\ptexstar=\*
106 \let\ptexsup=\sup
107 \let\ptext=\t
108 \let\ptextop=\top
109 {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
111 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
112 % starts a new line in the output.
113 \newlinechar = `^^J
115 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
116 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
118 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
119 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
120 \else
121 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
124 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
125 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
127 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
156 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
157 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
159 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
160 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
161 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
162 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
163 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
165 % Give the space character the catcode for a space.
166 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =10\relax}
168 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
169 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
170 \chardef\underChar = `\_
172 % Ignore a token.
174 \def\gobble#1{}
176 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
177 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
179 % Hyphenation fixes.
180 \hyphenation{
181 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
182 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
183 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
184 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
185 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
186 spell-ing spell-ings
187 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
188 wide-spread wrap-around
191 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
192 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
193 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
194 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
195 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
197 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
198 \def\loggingall{%
199 \tracingstats2
200 \tracingpages1
201 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
202 \tracingparagraphs1
203 \tracingoutput1
204 \tracingmacros2
205 \tracingrestores1
206 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
207 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
208 \tracingscantokens1
209 \tracingifs1
210 \tracinggroups1
211 \tracingnesting2
212 \tracingassigns1
214 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
215 \errorcontextlines16
218 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
219 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
220 % after all.
222 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
223 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
225 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
226 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
228 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
229 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
230 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
231 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
232 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
233 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
235 %\f Output routine
238 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
239 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
240 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
242 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
244 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
246 \newif\ifcropmarks
247 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
249 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
250 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
252 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
253 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
254 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
255 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
257 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
258 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
259 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
261 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
262 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
264 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
265 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
266 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.
268 % \domark is called twice inside \chapmacro, to add one
269 % mark before the section break, and one after.
270 % In the second call \prevchapterdefs is the same as \lastchapterdefs,
271 % and \prevsectiondefs is the same as \lastsectiondefs.
272 % Then if the page is not broken at the mark, some of the previous
273 % section appears on the page, and we can get the name of this section
274 % from \firstmark for @everyheadingmarks top.
275 % @everyheadingmarks bottom uses \botmark.
277 % See page 260 of The TeXbook.
278 \def\domark{%
279 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
280 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
281 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
282 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
283 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
284 \mark{%
285 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: marks for @everyheadingmarks top
286 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: for @everyheadingmarks bottom
287 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
291 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks,
292 % \getcolormarks - extract needed part of mark.
294 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
295 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
296 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
297 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
298 % first @chapter.
299 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
300 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
301 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
303 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
304 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
306 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
307 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
308 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
309 \def\lastsection{}
310 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
311 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
312 \def\lastcolordefs{}
314 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
315 \newdimen\bindingoffset
316 \newdimen\normaloffset
317 \newdimen\txipagewidth \newdimen\txipageheight
319 % Main output routine.
321 \chardef\PAGE = 255
322 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
324 \newbox\headlinebox
325 \newbox\footlinebox
327 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.
328 % \shipout a vbox for a single page, adding an optional header, footer,
329 % cropmarks, and footnote. This also causes index entries for this page
330 % to be written to the auxiliary files.
332 \def\onepageout#1{%
333 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
335 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
336 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
338 % Common context changes for both heading and footing.
339 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
340 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
341 \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\txipagewidth \texinfochars}
343 % Retrieve the information for the headings from the marks in the page,
344 % and call Plain TeX's \makeheadline and \makefootline, which use the
345 % values in \headline and \footline.
347 % This is used to check if we are on the first page of a chapter.
348 \ifcase1\topmark\fi
349 \let\prevchaptername\thischaptername
350 \ifcase0\firstmark\fi
351 \let\curchaptername\thischaptername
353 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
354 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
356 \ifx\curchaptername\prevchaptername
357 \let\thischapterheading\thischapter
358 \else
359 % \thischapterheading is the same as \thischapter except it is blank
360 % for the first page of a chapter. This is to prevent the chapter name
361 % being shown twice.
362 \def\thischapterheading{}%
365 \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
366 \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
369 % Set context for writing to auxiliary files like index files.
370 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
371 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
372 % before the \shipout runs.
374 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
375 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
376 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
377 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
378 % \entry{{\indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
379 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
380 % it needs to be
381 % {\code {{\backslashcurfont }acronym}
382 \shipout\vbox{%
383 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
384 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
386 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
387 \hsize = \outerhsize
388 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
389 \vtop to0pt{%
390 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
391 \nointerlineskip
392 \line{%
393 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
394 \hfill
395 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
397 \vss}%
398 \vskip\topandbottommargin
399 \line\bgroup
400 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
401 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
402 \vbox\bgroup
405 \unvbox\headlinebox
406 \pagebody{#1}%
407 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
408 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
409 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
410 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
411 \vskip 24pt
412 \unvbox\footlinebox
415 \ifcropmarks
416 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
417 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
418 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
419 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
420 \vbox to0pt{\vss
421 \line{%
422 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
423 \hfill
424 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
426 \nointerlineskip
427 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
429 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
431 }% end of \shipout\vbox
432 }% end of group with \indexdummies
433 \advancepageno
434 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
437 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
439 % Main part of page, including any footnotes
440 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\txipageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
441 {\catcode`\@ =11
442 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
443 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
444 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
445 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
446 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
447 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
448 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
451 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
452 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
453 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
455 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
456 \def\nstop{\vbox
457 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
458 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
459 \def\nsbot{\vbox
460 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
463 % Argument parsing
465 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
466 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
467 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
468 % For example, \def\foo{\parsearg\fooxxx}.
470 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
471 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
472 \def\argtorun{#2}%
473 \begingroup
474 \obeylines
475 \spaceisspace
477 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
480 {\obeylines %
481 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
482 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
483 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
487 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. Also remove a @texinfoc
488 % comment (see \scanmacro for details). Pass the result on to \argcheckspaces.
489 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
490 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argremovetexinfoc #1\texinfoc\ArgTerm}
491 \def\argremovetexinfoc#1\texinfoc#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
493 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
495 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
496 % @end itemize @c foo
497 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
498 % by \finishparsearg.
500 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
501 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
502 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
503 \def\temp{#3}%
504 \ifx\temp\empty
505 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
506 \let\temp\finishparsearg
507 \else
508 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
510 % Put the space token in:
511 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
514 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
515 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
516 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
517 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
518 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
519 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
520 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
522 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
524 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
527 % \parseargdef - define a command taking an argument on the line
529 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
530 % is roughly equivalent to
531 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
532 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
533 \def\parseargdef#1{%
534 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
536 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
537 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
538 \def#1##1%
541 % Several utility definitions with active space:
543 \obeyspaces
544 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
546 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
547 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
548 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
549 % should produce a line of output anyway.
551 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
553 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
554 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
555 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
556 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
560 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
562 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
564 % \envdef\foo{...}
565 % \def\Efoo{...}
567 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
568 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
569 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
570 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
571 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
573 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
574 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
575 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
576 % special case.)
579 % At run-time, environments start with this:
580 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
581 % initialize
582 \let\thisenv\empty
584 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
585 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
586 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
588 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
589 \def\checkenv#1{%
590 \def\temp{#1}%
591 \ifx\thisenv\temp
592 \else
593 \badenverr
597 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
598 \def\badenverr{%
599 \errhelp = \EMsimple
600 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
601 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
603 \def\inenvironment#1{%
604 \ifx#1\empty
605 outside of any environment%
606 \else
607 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
611 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
612 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
614 \parseargdef\end{%
615 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
616 \else
617 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
618 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
619 \csname E#1\endcsname
620 \endgroup
624 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
627 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
628 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
629 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
630 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
631 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
632 {\catcode`@ = 11
633 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
634 % if the definition is written into an index file.
635 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
636 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
639 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
640 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
642 % @* forces a line break.
643 \def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
645 % @/ allows a line break.
646 \let\/=\allowbreak
648 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
649 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
651 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
652 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
654 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
655 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
657 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
659 \def\onword{on}
660 \def\offword{off}
662 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
663 \def\temp{#1}%
664 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
665 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
666 \else
667 \errhelp = \EMsimple
668 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
669 \fi\fi
672 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
673 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
674 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
675 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
677 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
678 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
679 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
680 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
681 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
682 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
683 % the text is small, which looks bad.
685 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
686 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
687 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
688 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
689 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
690 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
692 \newbox\groupbox
693 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
695 \envdef\group{%
696 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
697 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
698 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
700 \startsavinginserts
702 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
703 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
704 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
705 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
706 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
707 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
708 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
709 \comment
712 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
713 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
714 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
715 % above. But it's pretty close.
716 \def\Egroup{%
717 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
718 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
719 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
720 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
721 \egroup % End the \vtop.
722 \addgroupbox
723 \prevdepth = \dimen1
724 \checkinserts
727 \def\addgroupbox{
728 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
729 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
730 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
731 \dimen2 = \txipageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
732 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
733 % group, force a page break.
734 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
735 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\txipageheight
736 \page
739 \box\groupbox
743 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
744 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
746 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
747 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
748 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
750 % @need space-in-mils
751 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
753 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
755 \parseargdef\need{%
756 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
757 % paragraph.
758 \par
760 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
761 \dimen0 = #1\mil
762 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
763 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
764 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
766 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
767 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
768 % And a page break here is fine.
769 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
771 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
772 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
773 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
774 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
775 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
777 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
778 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
779 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
780 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
781 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
782 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
783 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
784 \penalty9999
786 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
787 \kern -#1\mil
789 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
790 \nobreak
794 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
796 \let\br = \par
798 % @page forces the start of a new page.
800 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
802 % @exdent text....
803 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
805 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
806 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
807 \newskip\exdentamount
809 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
810 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
812 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
813 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
814 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
816 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
817 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
818 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
820 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
821 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
823 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
824 \nobreak
825 \kern-\strutdepth
826 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
827 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
828 \vss
829 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
830 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
831 \ifx#1l%
832 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
833 \else
834 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
836 \null
839 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
840 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
842 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
843 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
844 % else use TEXT for both).
846 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
847 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
848 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
849 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
850 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
851 \def\righttext{#2}%
852 \else
853 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
854 \def\righttext{#1}%
857 \ifodd\pageno
858 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
859 \else
860 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
862 \temp
865 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
867 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
868 \def\includezzz#1{%
869 \pushthisfilestack
870 \def\thisfile{#1}%
872 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
873 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
874 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
875 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
876 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
878 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
879 % definitions, etc.
880 \expandafter
881 }\temp
882 \popthisfilestack
884 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
885 \catcode`\\=\other
886 \catcode`~=\other
887 \catcode`^=\other
888 \catcode`_=\other
889 \catcode`|=\other
890 \catcode`<=\other
891 \catcode`>=\other
892 \catcode`+=\other
893 \catcode`-=\other
894 \catcode`\`=\other
895 \catcode`\'=\other
898 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
899 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
901 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
902 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
904 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
905 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
908 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
909 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
910 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
912 \def\thisfile{}
914 % @center line
915 % outputs that line, centered.
917 \parseargdef\center{%
918 \ifhmode
919 \let\centersub\centerH
920 \else
921 \let\centersub\centerV
923 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
924 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
926 \def\centerH#1{{%
927 \hfil\break
928 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
929 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
930 \line{#1}%
931 \break
934 \newcount\centerpenalty
935 \def\centerV#1{%
936 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
937 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
938 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
939 % prevent a page break here.
940 \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
941 \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
942 \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
943 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
946 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
948 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
950 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
951 % @c is the same as @comment
952 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
954 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
955 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other\commentxxx}%
957 {\catcode`\^^M=\active%
958 \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup%
959 \futurelet\nexttoken\commentxxxx}%
960 \gdef\commentxxxx{\ifx\nexttoken\aftermacro\expandafter\comment\fi}%
963 \def\c{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\active%
964 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
965 \cxxx}
966 {\catcode`\^^M=\active \gdef\cxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
967 % See comment in \scanmacro about why the definitions of @c and @comment differ
969 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
970 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
971 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
972 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
974 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
975 \def\noneword{none}
977 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
978 \def\temp{#1}%
979 \ifx\temp\asisword
980 \else
981 \ifx\temp\noneword
982 \defaultparindent = 0pt
983 \else
984 \defaultparindent = #1em
987 \parindent = \defaultparindent
990 % @exampleindent NCHARS
991 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
992 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
993 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
994 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
995 \def\temp{#1}%
996 \ifx\temp\asisword
997 \else
998 \ifx\temp\noneword
999 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
1000 \else
1001 \lispnarrowing = #1em
1006 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
1007 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
1008 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
1009 % paragraphs.
1011 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
1012 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
1013 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
1014 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1016 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1017 \def\insertword{insert}
1019 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1020 \def\temp{#1}%
1021 \ifx\temp\noneword
1022 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1023 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1024 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1025 \else
1026 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1027 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1028 \fi\fi
1031 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1032 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1034 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1035 % paragraph.
1037 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1038 \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}%
1039 \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}%
1040 \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}%
1043 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1044 \global\let\indent = \ptexindent
1045 \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent
1046 \global\everypar = {}%
1050 % @refill is a no-op.
1051 \let\refill=\relax
1053 % @setfilename INFO-FILENAME - ignored
1054 \let\setfilename=\comment
1056 % @bye.
1057 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1060 \message{pdf,}
1061 % adobe `portable' document format
1062 \newcount\tempnum
1063 \newcount\lnkcount
1064 \newtoks\filename
1065 \newcount\filenamelength
1066 \newcount\pgn
1067 \newtoks\toksA
1068 \newtoks\toksB
1069 \newtoks\toksC
1070 \newtoks\toksD
1071 \newbox\boxA
1072 \newbox\boxB
1073 \newcount\countA
1074 \newif\ifpdf
1075 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1078 % For LuaTeX
1081 \newif\iftxiuseunicodedestname
1082 \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse % For pdfTeX etc.
1084 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
1085 \else
1086 % Use Unicode destination names
1087 \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
1088 % Escape PDF strings with converting UTF-16 from UTF-8
1089 \begingroup
1090 \catcode`\%=12
1091 \directlua{
1092 function UTF16oct(str)
1093 tex.sprint(string.char(0x5c) .. '376' .. string.char(0x5c) .. '377')
1094 for c in string.utfvalues(str) do
1095 if c < 0x10000 then
1096 tex.sprint(
1097 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1098 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1099 (c / 256), (c % 256)))
1100 else
1101 c = c - 0x10000
1102 local c_hi = c / 1024 + 0xd800
1103 local c_lo = c % 1024 + 0xdc00
1104 tex.sprint(
1105 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1106 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1107 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o' ..
1108 string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1109 (c_hi / 256), (c_hi % 256),
1110 (c_lo / 256), (c_lo % 256)))
1115 \endgroup
1116 \def\pdfescapestrutfsixteen#1{\directlua{UTF16oct('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
1117 % Escape PDF strings without converting
1118 \begingroup
1119 \directlua{
1120 function PDFescstr(str)
1121 for c in string.bytes(str) do
1122 if c <= 0x20 or c >= 0x80 or c == 0x28 or c == 0x29 or c == 0x5c then
1123 tex.sprint(
1124 string.format(string.char(0x5c) .. string.char(0x25) .. '03o',
1126 else
1127 tex.sprint(string.char(c))
1132 \endgroup
1133 \def\pdfescapestring#1{\directlua{PDFescstr('\luaescapestring{#1}')}}
1134 \ifnum\luatexversion>84
1135 % For LuaTeX >= 0.85
1136 \def\pdfdest{\pdfextension dest}
1137 \let\pdfoutput\outputmode
1138 \def\pdfliteral{\pdfextension literal}
1139 \def\pdfcatalog{\pdfextension catalog}
1140 \def\pdftexversion{\numexpr\pdffeedback version\relax}
1141 \let\pdfximage\saveimageresource
1142 \let\pdfrefximage\useimageresource
1143 \let\pdflastximage\lastsavedimageresourceindex
1144 \def\pdfendlink{\pdfextension endlink\relax}
1145 \def\pdfoutline{\pdfextension outline}
1146 \def\pdfstartlink{\pdfextension startlink}
1147 \def\pdffontattr{\pdfextension fontattr}
1148 \def\pdfobj{\pdfextension obj}
1149 \def\pdflastobj{\numexpr\pdffeedback lastobj\relax}
1150 \let\pdfpagewidth\pagewidth
1151 \let\pdfpageheight\pageheight
1152 \edef\pdfhorigin{\pdfvariable horigin}
1153 \edef\pdfvorigin{\pdfvariable vorigin}
1157 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1158 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1159 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1160 \else
1161 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1162 \else
1163 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1164 \else
1165 \pdftrue
1170 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1171 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1172 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1173 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1175 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1176 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1177 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1178 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1179 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1181 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1182 % which we \xdef.
1183 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1184 \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
1185 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1186 % Many times it won't matter.
1187 \xdef#1{#1}%
1188 \else
1189 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1190 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1191 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1194 \def\txiescapepdfutfsixteen#1{%
1195 \ifx\pdfescapestrutfsixteen\thisisundefined
1196 % No UTF-16 converting macro available.
1197 \txiescapepdf{#1}%
1198 \else
1199 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestrutfsixteen{#1}}%
1203 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1204 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1205 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1206 output) for that.)}
1208 \ifpdf
1210 % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
1211 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1212 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1213 % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
1214 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
1215 % black by default, though.
1216 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1217 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1219 % rg sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1220 % RG sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1221 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
1223 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1224 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1225 \def\setcolor#1{%
1226 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1227 \domark
1228 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1231 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1232 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1233 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1234 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1236 \def\makefootline{%
1237 \baselineskip24pt
1238 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1241 \def\makeheadline{%
1242 \vbox to 0pt{%
1243 \vskip-22.5pt
1244 \line{%
1245 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1246 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1247 \getcolormarks
1248 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1249 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1251 \vss
1253 \nointerlineskip
1257 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1259 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1260 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1261 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1262 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1264 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1265 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1266 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1267 % bitmap.
1268 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1269 \begingroup
1270 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1271 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1272 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1273 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1274 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1275 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1276 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1277 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1278 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1280 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1282 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1284 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1286 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
1288 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1290 \closein 1
1291 \endgroup
1293 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1294 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1295 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1296 \immediate\pdfimage
1297 \else
1298 \immediate\pdfximage
1300 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
1301 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
1302 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1303 #1.\pdfimgext
1304 \else
1305 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1307 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1308 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1309 \fi}
1311 \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
1312 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1313 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1314 \indexnofonts
1315 \makevalueexpandable
1316 \turnoffactive
1317 \iftxiuseunicodedestname
1318 \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
1319 % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
1320 % LuaTeX with byte wise I/O converts Latin-1 characters to Unicode.
1321 \else
1322 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
1323 % Pass through Unicode characters.
1324 \else
1325 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1326 \passthroughcharsfalse
1329 \else
1330 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1331 \passthroughcharsfalse
1333 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1334 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1337 \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
1338 \indexnofonts
1339 \makevalueexpandable
1340 \turnoffactive
1341 \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
1342 % The PDF format can use an extended form of Latin-1 in bookmark
1343 % strings. See Appendix D of the PDF Reference, Sixth Edition, for
1344 % the "PDFDocEncoding".
1345 \passthroughcharstrue
1346 % Pass through Latin-1 characters.
1347 % LuaTeX: Convert to Unicode
1348 % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
1349 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1350 \else
1351 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
1352 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
1353 % For pdfTeX with UTF-8.
1354 % TODO: the PDF format can use UTF-16 in bookmark strings,
1355 % but the code for this isn't done yet.
1356 % Use ASCII approximations.
1357 \passthroughcharsfalse
1358 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1359 \else
1360 % For LuaTeX with UTF-8.
1361 % Pass through Unicode characters for title texts.
1362 \passthroughcharstrue
1363 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1365 \else
1366 % For non-Latin-1 or non-UTF-8 encodings.
1367 % Use ASCII approximations.
1368 \passthroughcharsfalse
1369 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1372 % LuaTeX: Convert to UTF-16
1373 % pdfTeX: Use Latin-1 as PDFDocEncoding
1374 \txiescapepdfutfsixteen\pdfoutlinetext
1377 \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
1378 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
1379 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1382 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1383 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1385 % by default, use black for everything.
1386 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1387 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1388 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1390 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1391 % come from Petr Olsak
1392 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1393 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1394 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1395 \advance\tempnum by 1
1396 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1398 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1399 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1400 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1401 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1402 % #4 is the page number
1404 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1405 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1406 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1407 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1408 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1409 \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
1410 \setpdfdestname{#3}
1411 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
1412 \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
1415 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1418 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1419 \begingroup
1420 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1421 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1422 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1423 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1424 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1425 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1427 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1428 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1429 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1430 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1432 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1433 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1434 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1436 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1437 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1439 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1440 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1441 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1443 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1444 % al. a second time, below.
1445 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1446 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1447 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1448 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1449 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1450 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1451 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1452 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1453 \readdatafile{toc}%
1455 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1456 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1457 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1459 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1460 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1461 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1462 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1463 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1464 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1465 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1466 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1467 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1469 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1470 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1471 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1472 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1473 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1475 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1476 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1477 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1478 % we use for the index sort strings.
1480 \indexnofonts
1481 \setupdatafile
1482 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1483 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1484 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1485 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1486 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1487 \input \tocreadfilename
1488 \endgroup
1490 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1491 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1492 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1493 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1496 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1497 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1498 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1499 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1500 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1502 \nextsp}
1503 \def\getfilename#1{%
1504 \filenamelength=0
1505 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1506 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1507 \edef\temp{#1}%
1508 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1510 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1511 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1512 \else
1513 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1515 % make a live url in pdf output.
1516 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1517 \begingroup
1518 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1519 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1520 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1521 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1523 \normalturnoffactive
1524 \def\@{@}%
1525 \let\/=\empty
1526 \makevalueexpandable
1527 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1528 % special-casing \var here?
1529 \def\var##1{##1}%
1531 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1532 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1533 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1534 \endgroup}
1535 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1536 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1537 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1538 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1539 \def\maketoks{%
1540 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1541 \ifx\first0\adn0
1542 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1543 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1544 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1545 \else
1546 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1547 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1548 \let\next=\maketoks
1549 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1550 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1552 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1553 \next}
1554 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1555 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1556 \def\pdflink#1{%
1557 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1558 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1559 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1560 \else
1561 % non-pdf mode
1562 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1563 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1564 \let\endlink = \relax
1565 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1566 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1567 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1568 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1571 % For XeTeX
1573 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
1574 \else
1576 % XeTeX version check
1578 \ifnum\strcmp{\the\XeTeXversion\XeTeXrevision}{0.99996}>-1
1579 % TeX Live 2016 contains XeTeX 0.99996 and xdvipdfmx 20160307.
1580 % It can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special (from TeX Live SVN r40941).
1581 % For avoiding PDF destination name replacement, we use this special
1582 % instead of xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
1583 \special{dvipdfmx:config C 0x0010}
1584 % XeTeX 0.99995+ comes with xdvipdfmx 20160307+.
1585 % It can handle Unicode destination names for PDF.
1586 \txiuseunicodedestnametrue
1587 \else
1588 % XeTeX < 0.99996 (TeX Live < 2016) cannot use the
1589 % `dvipdfmx:config' special.
1590 % So for avoiding PDF destination name replacement,
1591 % xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010' is necessary.
1593 % XeTeX < 0.99995 can not handle Unicode destination names for PDF
1594 % because xdvipdfmx 20150315 has a UTF-16 conversion issue.
1595 % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
1596 \txiuseunicodedestnamefalse
1599 % Color support
1601 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1602 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1604 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\special{pdf:scolor [#1]}}
1606 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1607 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1608 \def\setcolor#1{%
1609 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1610 \domark
1611 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1614 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1615 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1616 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1617 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1619 \def\makefootline{%
1620 \baselineskip24pt
1621 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1624 \def\makeheadline{%
1625 \vbox to 0pt{%
1626 \vskip-22.5pt
1627 \line{%
1628 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1629 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1630 \getcolormarks
1631 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1632 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1634 \vss
1636 \nointerlineskip
1639 % PDF outline support
1641 % Emulate pdfTeX primitive
1642 \def\pdfdest name#1 xyz{%
1643 \special{pdf:dest (#1) [@thispage /XYZ @xpos @ypos null]}%
1646 \def\setpdfdestname#1{{%
1647 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1648 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1649 \indexnofonts
1650 \makevalueexpandable
1651 \turnoffactive
1652 \iftxiuseunicodedestname
1653 % Pass through Unicode characters.
1654 \else
1655 % Use ASCII approximations in destination names.
1656 \passthroughcharsfalse
1658 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1659 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1662 \def\setpdfoutlinetext#1{{%
1663 \turnoffactive
1664 % Always use Unicode characters in title texts.
1665 \def\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1666 % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts to UTF-16.
1667 % So we do not convert.
1668 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1671 \def\pdfmkdest#1{%
1672 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
1673 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1676 % by default, use black for everything.
1677 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1678 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1679 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1681 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1682 \setpdfoutlinetext{#1}
1683 \setpdfdestname{#3}
1684 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
1685 \def\pdfdestname{#4}%
1688 \special{pdf:out [-] #2 << /Title (\pdfoutlinetext) /A
1689 << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >> }%
1692 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1693 \begingroup
1695 % For XeTeX, counts of subentries are not necessary.
1696 % Therefore, we read toc only once.
1698 % We use node names as destinations.
1699 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1700 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1701 \dopdfoutline{##1}{1}{##3}{##4}}%
1702 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1703 \dopdfoutline{##1}{2}{##3}{##4}}%
1704 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1705 \dopdfoutline{##1}{3}{##3}{##4}}%
1706 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1707 \dopdfoutline{##1}{4}{##3}{##4}}%
1709 \let\appentry\numchapentry%
1710 \let\appsecentry\numsecentry%
1711 \let\appsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
1712 \let\appsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
1713 \let\unnchapentry\numchapentry%
1714 \let\unnsecentry\numsecentry%
1715 \let\unnsubsecentry\numsubsecentry%
1716 \let\unnsubsubsecentry\numsubsubsecentry%
1718 % For XeTeX, xdvipdfmx converts strings to UTF-16.
1719 % Therefore, the encoding and the language may not be considered.
1721 \indexnofonts
1722 \setupdatafile
1723 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1724 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1725 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1726 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1727 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1728 \input \tocreadfilename
1729 \endgroup
1731 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1732 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1733 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1734 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1737 \special{pdf:docview << /PageMode /UseOutlines >> }
1738 % ``\special{pdf:tounicode ...}'' is not necessary
1739 % because xdvipdfmx converts strings from UTF-8 to UTF-16 without it.
1740 % However, due to a UTF-16 conversion issue of xdvipdfmx 20150315,
1741 % ``\special{pdf:dest ...}'' cannot handle non-ASCII strings.
1742 % It is fixed by xdvipdfmx 20160106 (TeX Live SVN r39753).
1744 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1745 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1746 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1747 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1748 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1750 \nextsp}
1751 \def\getfilename#1{%
1752 \filenamelength=0
1753 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1754 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1755 \edef\temp{#1}%
1756 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1758 % make a live url in pdf output.
1759 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1760 \begingroup
1761 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1762 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1763 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1764 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1766 \normalturnoffactive
1767 \def\@{@}%
1768 \let\/=\empty
1769 \makevalueexpandable
1770 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1771 % special-casing \var here?
1772 \def\var##1{##1}%
1774 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1775 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
1776 /Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >> >>}%
1777 \endgroup}
1778 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\special{pdf:eann}}
1779 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1780 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1781 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1782 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1783 \def\maketoks{%
1784 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1785 \ifx\first0\adn0
1786 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1787 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1788 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1789 \else
1790 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1791 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1792 \let\next=\maketoks
1793 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1794 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1796 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1797 \next}
1798 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1799 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1800 \def\pdflink#1{%
1801 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0]
1802 /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A << /S /GoTo /D (#1) >> >>}%
1803 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1804 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1807 % @image support
1809 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1810 \def\doxeteximage#1#2#3{%
1811 \def\xeteximagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1812 \def\xeteximageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1814 % XeTeX (and the PDF format) supports .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1815 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1816 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1817 % bitmap.
1818 \let\xeteximgext=\empty
1819 \begingroup
1820 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1821 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1822 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1823 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1824 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1825 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1826 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for XeTeX}%
1827 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{JPG}%
1829 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpeg}%
1831 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{jpg}%
1833 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{png}%
1835 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{PDF}%
1837 \else \gdef\xeteximgext{pdf}%
1839 \closein 1
1840 \endgroup
1842 \def\xetexpdfext{pdf}%
1843 \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
1844 \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1845 \else
1846 \def\xetexpdfext{PDF}%
1847 \ifx\xeteximgext\xetexpdfext
1848 \XeTeXpdffile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1849 \else
1850 \XeTeXpicfile "#1".\xeteximgext ""
1853 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \xeteximagewidth \fi
1854 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \xeteximageheight \fi \relax
1860 \message{fonts,}
1862 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1863 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1864 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1866 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1867 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1868 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1870 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1871 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1873 \newdimen\textleading
1874 \def\setleading#1{%
1875 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1876 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1877 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1878 \normalbaselines
1879 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1880 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1881 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1885 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1887 % do nothing with this by default.
1888 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1889 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1890 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1892 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1893 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1894 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1895 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1896 \begingroup
1897 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1898 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1899 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1900 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1901 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1902 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1903 %%Version: 1.000
1904 %%EndComments
1905 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1906 12 dict begin
1907 begincmap
1908 /CIDSystemInfo
1909 << /Registry (TeX)
1910 /Ordering (OT1)
1911 /Supplement 0
1912 >> def
1913 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1914 /CMapType 2 def
1915 1 begincodespacerange
1916 <00> <7F>
1917 endcodespacerange
1918 8 beginbfrange
1919 <00> <01> <0393>
1920 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1921 <23> <26> <0023>
1922 <28> <3B> <0028>
1923 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1924 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1925 <61> <7A> <0061>
1926 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1927 endbfrange
1928 40 beginbfchar
1929 <02> <0398>
1930 <03> <039B>
1931 <04> <039E>
1932 <05> <03A0>
1933 <06> <03A3>
1934 <07> <03D2>
1935 <08> <03A6>
1936 <0B> <00660066>
1937 <0C> <00660069>
1938 <0D> <0066006C>
1939 <0E> <006600660069>
1940 <0F> <00660066006C>
1941 <10> <0131>
1942 <11> <0237>
1943 <12> <0060>
1944 <13> <00B4>
1945 <14> <02C7>
1946 <15> <02D8>
1947 <16> <00AF>
1948 <17> <02DA>
1949 <18> <00B8>
1950 <19> <00DF>
1951 <1A> <00E6>
1952 <1B> <0153>
1953 <1C> <00F8>
1954 <1D> <00C6>
1955 <1E> <0152>
1956 <1F> <00D8>
1957 <21> <0021>
1958 <22> <201D>
1959 <27> <2019>
1960 <3C> <00A1>
1961 <3D> <003D>
1962 <3E> <00BF>
1963 <5C> <201C>
1964 <5F> <02D9>
1965 <60> <2018>
1966 <7D> <02DD>
1967 <7E> <007E>
1968 <7F> <00A8>
1969 endbfchar
1970 endcmap
1971 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1974 %%EndResource
1975 %%EOF
1976 }\endgroup
1977 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1978 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1981 % \cmapOT1IT
1982 \begingroup
1983 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1984 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1985 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1986 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1987 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1988 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1989 %%Version: 1.000
1990 %%EndComments
1991 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1992 12 dict begin
1993 begincmap
1994 /CIDSystemInfo
1995 << /Registry (TeX)
1996 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1997 /Supplement 0
1998 >> def
1999 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
2000 /CMapType 2 def
2001 1 begincodespacerange
2002 <00> <7F>
2003 endcodespacerange
2004 8 beginbfrange
2005 <00> <01> <0393>
2006 <09> <0A> <03A8>
2007 <25> <26> <0025>
2008 <28> <3B> <0028>
2009 <3F> <5B> <003F>
2010 <5D> <5E> <005D>
2011 <61> <7A> <0061>
2012 <7B> <7C> <2013>
2013 endbfrange
2014 42 beginbfchar
2015 <02> <0398>
2016 <03> <039B>
2017 <04> <039E>
2018 <05> <03A0>
2019 <06> <03A3>
2020 <07> <03D2>
2021 <08> <03A6>
2022 <0B> <00660066>
2023 <0C> <00660069>
2024 <0D> <0066006C>
2025 <0E> <006600660069>
2026 <0F> <00660066006C>
2027 <10> <0131>
2028 <11> <0237>
2029 <12> <0060>
2030 <13> <00B4>
2031 <14> <02C7>
2032 <15> <02D8>
2033 <16> <00AF>
2034 <17> <02DA>
2035 <18> <00B8>
2036 <19> <00DF>
2037 <1A> <00E6>
2038 <1B> <0153>
2039 <1C> <00F8>
2040 <1D> <00C6>
2041 <1E> <0152>
2042 <1F> <00D8>
2043 <21> <0021>
2044 <22> <201D>
2045 <23> <0023>
2046 <24> <00A3>
2047 <27> <2019>
2048 <3C> <00A1>
2049 <3D> <003D>
2050 <3E> <00BF>
2051 <5C> <201C>
2052 <5F> <02D9>
2053 <60> <2018>
2054 <7D> <02DD>
2055 <7E> <007E>
2056 <7F> <00A8>
2057 endbfchar
2058 endcmap
2059 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
2062 %%EndResource
2063 %%EOF
2064 }\endgroup
2065 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
2066 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
2069 % \cmapOT1TT
2070 \begingroup
2071 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
2072 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
2073 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
2074 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
2075 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
2076 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
2077 %%Version: 1.000
2078 %%EndComments
2079 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
2080 12 dict begin
2081 begincmap
2082 /CIDSystemInfo
2083 << /Registry (TeX)
2084 /Ordering (OT1TT)
2085 /Supplement 0
2086 >> def
2087 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
2088 /CMapType 2 def
2089 1 begincodespacerange
2090 <00> <7F>
2091 endcodespacerange
2092 5 beginbfrange
2093 <00> <01> <0393>
2094 <09> <0A> <03A8>
2095 <21> <26> <0021>
2096 <28> <5F> <0028>
2097 <61> <7E> <0061>
2098 endbfrange
2099 32 beginbfchar
2100 <02> <0398>
2101 <03> <039B>
2102 <04> <039E>
2103 <05> <03A0>
2104 <06> <03A3>
2105 <07> <03D2>
2106 <08> <03A6>
2107 <0B> <2191>
2108 <0C> <2193>
2109 <0D> <0027>
2110 <0E> <00A1>
2111 <0F> <00BF>
2112 <10> <0131>
2113 <11> <0237>
2114 <12> <0060>
2115 <13> <00B4>
2116 <14> <02C7>
2117 <15> <02D8>
2118 <16> <00AF>
2119 <17> <02DA>
2120 <18> <00B8>
2121 <19> <00DF>
2122 <1A> <00E6>
2123 <1B> <0153>
2124 <1C> <00F8>
2125 <1D> <00C6>
2126 <1E> <0152>
2127 <1F> <00D8>
2128 <20> <2423>
2129 <27> <2019>
2130 <60> <2018>
2131 <7F> <00A8>
2132 endbfchar
2133 endcmap
2134 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
2137 %%EndResource
2138 %%EOF
2139 }\endgroup
2140 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
2141 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
2143 \fi\fi
2146 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
2147 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
2148 % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
2149 % Example:
2150 % #1 = \textrm
2151 % #2 = \rmshape
2152 % #3 = 10
2153 % #4 = \mainmagstep
2154 % #5 = OT1
2156 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
2157 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
2158 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
2160 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
2161 \let\cmap\gobble
2163 % (end of cmaps)
2165 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
2166 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
2167 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
2168 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
2169 \def\fontprefix{cm}
2171 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
2172 \def\rmshape{r}
2173 \def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
2174 \def\bfshape{b}
2175 \def\bxshape{bx}
2176 \def\ttshape{tt}
2177 \def\ttbshape{tt}
2178 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
2179 \def\itshape{ti}
2180 \def\itbshape{bxti}
2181 \def\slshape{sl}
2182 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
2183 \def\sfshape{ss}
2184 \def\sfbshape{ss}
2185 \def\scshape{csc}
2186 \def\scbshape{csc}
2188 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
2190 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
2191 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
2192 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
2193 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
2194 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2195 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2196 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2197 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2198 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2199 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2200 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2201 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2202 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2203 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2204 \def\textecsize{1095}
2206 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2207 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2208 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2209 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2210 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2211 \def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
2212 \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \let\slfont=\defsl \bf}
2214 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2215 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2216 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2217 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2218 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2219 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2220 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2221 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2222 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2223 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2224 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2225 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2226 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2228 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2229 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2230 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2231 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2232 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2233 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2234 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2235 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2236 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2237 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2238 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2239 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2240 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2242 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2243 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2244 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2245 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2246 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2247 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2248 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2249 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2250 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2251 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2252 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2253 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2254 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2256 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
2257 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
2258 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2259 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
2260 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2261 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2262 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2263 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
2264 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
2265 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2266 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
2267 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
2268 \def\chapecsize{1728}
2270 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
2271 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
2272 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2273 \setfont\secrmnotbold\rmshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2274 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2275 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2276 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2277 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2278 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2279 \let\secbf\secrm
2280 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2281 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2282 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2283 \def\sececsize{1440}
2285 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
2286 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
2287 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2288 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
2289 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2290 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2291 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
2292 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2293 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2294 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2295 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
2296 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
2297 \def\ssececsize{1200}
2299 % Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (10pt).
2300 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
2301 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2302 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2303 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2304 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2305 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2306 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2307 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2308 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2309 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
2310 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
2311 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
2313 \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
2314 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2316 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
2319 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
2320 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
2321 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
2322 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
2324 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
2325 % Text fonts (10pt).
2326 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
2327 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
2328 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2329 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2330 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2331 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2332 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2333 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2334 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2335 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2336 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2337 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2338 \def\textecsize{1000}
2340 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2341 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2342 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2343 \setfont\defsl\slshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2344 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2345 \def\df{\let\ttfont=\deftt \let\bffont = \defbf
2346 \let\slfont=\defsl \let\ttslfont=\defttsl \bf}
2348 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2349 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2350 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2351 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2352 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2353 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2354 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2355 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2356 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2357 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2358 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2359 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2360 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2362 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2363 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2364 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2365 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2366 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2367 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2368 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2369 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2370 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2371 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2372 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2373 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2374 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2376 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2377 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2378 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2379 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2380 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2381 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2382 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2383 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2384 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2385 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2386 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2387 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2388 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2390 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2391 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2392 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2393 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2394 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2395 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2396 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2397 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2398 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2399 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2400 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2401 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2402 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2404 % Section fonts (12pt).
2405 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2406 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2407 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2408 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2409 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2410 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2411 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2412 \let\secbf\secrm
2413 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2414 \font\seci=cmmi12
2415 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2416 \def\sececsize{1200}
2418 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2419 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2420 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2421 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2422 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2423 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2424 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2425 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2426 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2427 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2428 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2429 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2430 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2432 % Reduced fonts for @acronym in text (9pt).
2433 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2434 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2435 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2436 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2437 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2438 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2439 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2440 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2441 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2442 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2443 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2444 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2446 \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2447 \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
2448 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2450 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
2452 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2453 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2454 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2455 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2456 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2459 % We provide the user-level command
2460 % @fonttextsize 10
2461 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2463 \def\xiword{11}
2464 \def\xword{10}
2465 \def\xwordpt{10pt}
2467 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2468 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2469 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2471 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2472 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2474 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2475 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2476 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2477 \else
2478 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2479 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2480 \fi\fi
2481 \endgroup
2485 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
2486 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
2487 % italics, not bold italics.
2489 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
2490 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
2491 \csname #1font\endcsname % change the current font
2494 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
2495 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
2496 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
2497 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
2498 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
2500 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
2501 % So we set up a \sf.
2502 \newfam\sffam
2503 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
2505 % We don't need math for this font style.
2506 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
2509 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2510 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. We don't
2511 % bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need.
2513 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2514 \textfont0=\rmfont \textfont1=\ifont \textfont2=\syfont
2515 \textfont\itfam=\itfont \textfont\slfam=\slfont \textfont\bffam=\bffont
2516 \textfont\ttfam=\ttfont \textfont\sffam=\sffont
2521 % The font-changing commands (all called \...fonts) redefine the meanings
2522 % of \STYLEfont, instead of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs
2523 % to also set the current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm)
2524 % commands hardwire \STYLEfont to set the current font.
2526 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2527 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used
2528 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2530 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2533 \def\assignfonts#1{%
2534 \expandafter\let\expandafter\rmfont\csname #1rm\endcsname
2535 \expandafter\let\expandafter\itfont\csname #1it\endcsname
2536 \expandafter\let\expandafter\slfont\csname #1sl\endcsname
2537 \expandafter\let\expandafter\bffont\csname #1bf\endcsname
2538 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttfont\csname #1tt\endcsname
2539 \expandafter\let\expandafter\smallcaps\csname #1sc\endcsname
2540 \expandafter\let\expandafter\sffont \csname #1sf\endcsname
2541 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ifont \csname #1i\endcsname
2542 \expandafter\let\expandafter\syfont \csname #1sy\endcsname
2543 \expandafter\let\expandafter\ttslfont\csname #1ttsl\endcsname
2546 \newif\ifrmisbold
2548 % Select smaller font size with the current style. Used to change font size
2549 % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms. If we are using bold fonts for
2550 % normal roman text, also use bold fonts for roman text in the smaller size.
2551 \def\switchtolllsize{%
2552 \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lllsize}%
2553 \ifrmisbold
2554 \let\rmfont\bffont
2556 \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
2559 \def\switchtolsize{%
2560 \expandafter\assignfonts\expandafter{\lsize}%
2561 \ifrmisbold
2562 \let\rmfont\bffont
2564 \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname
2567 \def\definefontsetatsize#1#2#3#4#5{%
2568 \expandafter\def\csname #1fonts\endcsname{%
2569 \def\curfontsize{#1}%
2570 \def\lsize{#2}\def\lllsize{#3}%
2571 \csname rmisbold#5\endcsname
2572 \assignfonts{#1}%
2573 \resetmathfonts
2574 \setleading{#4}%
2577 \definefontsetatsize{text} {reduced}{smaller}{\textleading}{false}
2578 \definefontsetatsize{title} {chap} {subsec} {27pt} {true}
2579 \definefontsetatsize{chap} {sec} {text} {19pt} {true}
2580 \definefontsetatsize{sec} {subsec} {reduced}{17pt} {true}
2581 \definefontsetatsize{ssec} {text} {small} {15pt} {true}
2582 \definefontsetatsize{reduced}{small} {smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
2583 \definefontsetatsize{small} {smaller}{smaller}{10.5pt}{false}
2584 \definefontsetatsize{smaller}{smaller}{smaller}{9.5pt} {false}
2586 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
2587 \let\subsecfonts = \ssecfonts
2588 \let\subsubsecfonts = \ssecfonts
2590 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2591 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2592 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2594 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2595 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2597 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2598 % can fit this many characters:
2599 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2600 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2601 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2602 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2603 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2605 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2606 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2607 % --karl, 24jan03.
2609 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2611 \definetextfontsizexi
2614 \message{markup,}
2616 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2617 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2618 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2619 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2621 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2623 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2624 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2625 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2626 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2627 % currently in effect.
2628 \newif\ifmarkupvar
2629 \newif\ifmarkupsamp
2630 \newif\ifmarkupkey
2631 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2632 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2633 \newif\ifmarkupcode
2634 \newif\ifmarkupkbd
2635 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2636 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2637 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2638 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2639 \newif\ifmarkupverb
2640 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2642 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2644 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2645 \csname markup#1true\endcsname
2646 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2647 \markupstylesetup
2650 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2652 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2653 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2654 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2655 \def#1%
2658 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2659 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2660 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2661 \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2662 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2665 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2666 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2667 \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2668 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2672 \catcode`\'=\active
2673 \catcode`\`=\active
2675 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
2676 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
2678 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
2679 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
2682 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2683 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2685 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2686 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2688 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
2689 \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
2691 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2692 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2694 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2695 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2697 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2698 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2700 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2701 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2702 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2703 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2704 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2706 \def\codequoteright{%
2707 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2708 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2710 \else \char'15 \fi
2711 \else \char'15 \fi
2714 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2715 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2716 % the code environments to do likewise.
2718 \def\codequoteleft{%
2719 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2720 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2721 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2722 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2723 \relax`%
2724 \else \char'22 \fi
2725 \else \char'22 \fi
2728 % Commands to set the quote options.
2730 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2731 \def\temp{#1}%
2732 \ifx\temp\onword
2733 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2734 = t%
2735 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2736 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2737 = \relax
2738 \else
2739 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2740 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2741 \fi\fi
2744 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2745 \def\temp{#1}%
2746 \ifx\temp\onword
2747 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2748 = t%
2749 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2750 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2751 = \relax
2752 \else
2753 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2754 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2755 \fi\fi
2758 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2759 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2761 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2762 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2764 % Font commands.
2766 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2767 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2768 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2769 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2770 \ifusingtt
2771 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
2772 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2773 \next
2775 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2776 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2778 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2779 % character) is such as not to need one.
2780 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2781 \ifx\next,%
2782 \else\ifx\next-%
2783 \else\ifx\next.%
2784 \else\ifx\next\.%
2785 \else\ifx\next\comma%
2786 \else\ptexslash
2787 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
2788 \aftersmartic
2791 % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
2792 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2794 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2795 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2796 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2798 \def\aftersmartic{}
2799 \def\var#1{%
2800 \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
2801 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
2802 \smartslanted{#1}%
2805 \let\i=\smartitalic
2806 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2807 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2808 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2810 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2811 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2812 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2813 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2815 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2816 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2817 \let\strong=\b
2819 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2820 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2822 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2823 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2824 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2826 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2827 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2829 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2830 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2831 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2833 \catcode`@=11
2834 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2835 \sfcode`\.=\@m \sfcode`\?=\@m \sfcode`\!=\@m
2836 \sfcode`\:=\@m \sfcode`\;=\@m \sfcode`\,=\@m
2837 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2839 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2840 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2841 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2842 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2844 \catcode`@=\other
2845 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2847 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2848 \def\t#1{%
2849 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2850 \null
2853 % @samp.
2854 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2856 % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
2857 \let\indicateurl=\samp
2859 % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
2860 % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
2861 % This is a subroutine for that.
2862 \def\tclose#1{%
2864 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2865 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2867 % Switch to typewriter.
2870 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2871 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2873 % Turn off hyphenation.
2874 \nohyphenation
2876 \rawbackslash
2877 \plainfrenchspacing
2880 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2883 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2884 % (But see \codedashfinish below.)
2885 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2886 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2888 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2889 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2890 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2891 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
2893 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2894 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2895 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
2897 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2898 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2899 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2900 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2901 \ifallowcodebreaks
2902 \let-\codedash
2903 \let_\codeunder
2904 \else
2905 \let-\normaldash
2906 \let_\realunder
2908 % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
2909 % after the hyphen.
2910 \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
2912 \codex
2915 \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
2916 \gdef\codedashfinish{%
2917 \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
2919 % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
2920 % (a) the next character is a -, or
2921 % (b) the preceding character is a -.
2922 % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
2923 % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
2924 \ifx\next\codedash \else
2925 \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
2926 \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
2928 % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
2929 % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
2930 \global\let\codedashprev= \next
2933 \def\normaldash{-}
2935 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2937 \def\codeunder{%
2938 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2939 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2940 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2941 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2942 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2943 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2944 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2945 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2946 {\_}%
2949 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2950 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
2951 % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
2952 % and _ on and off.
2954 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2956 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2957 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2959 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2960 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2961 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2962 \allowcodebreakstrue
2963 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2964 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2965 \else
2966 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2967 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
2968 \fi\fi
2971 % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
2972 % so use \code rather than \samp.
2973 \let\command=\code
2974 \let\env=\code
2975 \let\file=\code
2976 \let\option=\code
2978 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
2979 % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
2980 % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
2981 % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2983 % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
2984 % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
2985 \newif\ifurefurlonlylink
2987 % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
2988 % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
2989 % didn't support automatic breaking.)
2990 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2991 \let\uref=\urefbreak
2993 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
2994 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2995 \unsepspaces
2996 \pdfurl{#1}%
2997 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2998 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2999 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
3000 \else
3001 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
3002 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
3003 \ifpdf
3004 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
3005 \ifurefurlonlylink
3006 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
3007 \unhbox0
3008 \else
3009 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
3010 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
3011 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
3013 \else
3014 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
3015 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
3016 \else
3017 % For XeTeX
3018 \ifurefurlonlylink
3019 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
3020 \unhbox0
3021 \else
3022 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
3023 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
3024 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
3028 \else
3029 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
3032 \endlink
3033 \endgroup}
3035 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
3036 \def\urefcatcodes{%
3037 \catcode`\&=\active \catcode`\.=\active
3038 \catcode`\#=\active \catcode`\?=\active
3039 \catcode`\/=\active
3042 \urefcatcodes
3044 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
3045 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
3046 \urefcatcodes
3047 \let&\urefcodeamp
3048 \let.\urefcodedot
3049 \let#\urefcodehash
3050 \let?\urefcodequest
3051 \let/\urefcodeslash
3052 \codex
3055 % By default, they are just regular characters.
3056 \global\def&{\normalamp}
3057 \global\def.{\normaldot}
3058 \global\def#{\normalhash}
3059 \global\def?{\normalquest}
3060 \global\def/{\normalslash}
3063 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
3064 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
3065 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
3066 \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em}
3067 \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em}
3068 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
3069 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
3071 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch}
3072 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch}
3073 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch}
3074 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch}
3075 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
3077 \catcode`\/=\active
3078 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
3079 \urefprestretch \slashChar
3080 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
3081 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
3082 \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi
3086 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
3087 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
3088 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
3090 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
3091 \def\txiarg{#1}%
3092 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
3093 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
3094 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
3095 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
3096 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
3097 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
3098 \else
3099 \errhelp = \EMsimple
3100 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
3101 \fi\fi\fi
3103 \def\wordafter{after}
3104 \def\wordbefore{before}
3105 \def\wordnone{none}
3107 \urefbreakstyle after
3109 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
3111 \let\url=\uref
3113 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
3114 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
3116 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
3117 \ifpdf
3118 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
3119 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
3120 \unsepspaces
3121 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
3122 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
3123 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
3124 \endlink
3125 \endgroup}
3126 \else
3127 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
3128 \let\email=\uref
3129 \else
3130 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
3131 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
3132 \unsepspaces
3133 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
3134 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
3135 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
3136 \endlink
3137 \endgroup}
3141 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
3142 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
3143 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
3144 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
3145 \def\txiarg{#1}%
3146 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
3147 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
3148 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
3149 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
3150 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
3151 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
3152 \else
3153 \errhelp = \EMsimple
3154 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
3155 \fi\fi\fi
3157 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
3158 \def\wordexample{example}
3159 \def\wordcode{code}
3161 % Default is `distinct'.
3162 \kbdinputstyle distinct
3164 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
3165 % then @kbd has no effect.
3166 \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
3168 \def\xkey{\key}
3169 \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
3170 \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
3171 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
3172 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
3173 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
3176 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
3177 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
3178 %\font\keysy=cmsy9
3179 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
3180 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
3181 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
3182 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
3183 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
3184 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
3186 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
3187 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
3188 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
3190 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
3191 \nohyphenation
3192 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
3193 #1}\null}
3195 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
3196 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
3198 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
3199 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
3200 \def\click{\arrow}
3202 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
3203 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
3205 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
3207 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
3208 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
3209 % all-uppercase.
3211 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
3212 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
3213 {\switchtolsize #1}%
3214 \def\temp{#2}%
3215 \ifx\temp\empty \else
3216 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
3218 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
3221 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
3222 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
3224 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
3225 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
3226 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
3227 \def\temp{#2}%
3228 \ifx\temp\empty \else
3229 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
3231 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
3234 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
3236 \def\asis#1{#1}
3238 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
3240 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
3241 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
3242 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
3243 % which is what @var uses.
3245 \catcode`\_ = \active
3246 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
3247 \catcode`\_=\active
3248 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
3251 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
3252 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
3253 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
3255 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
3256 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
3258 \def\math{%
3259 \ifmmode\else % only go into math if not in math mode already
3260 \tex
3261 \mathunderscore
3262 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
3263 \mathactive
3264 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
3265 \let\"=\ddot
3266 \let\'=\acute
3267 \let\==\bar
3268 \let\^=\hat
3269 \let\`=\grave
3270 \let\u=\breve
3271 \let\v=\check
3272 \let\~=\tilde
3273 \let\dotaccent=\dot
3274 % have to provide another name for sup operator
3275 \let\mathopsup=\sup
3276 $\expandafter\finishmath\fi
3278 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
3280 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
3281 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
3282 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
3285 \catcode`^ = \active
3286 \catcode`< = \active
3287 \catcode`> = \active
3288 \catcode`+ = \active
3289 \catcode`' = \active
3290 \gdef\mathactive{%
3291 \let^ = \ptexhat
3292 \let< = \ptexless
3293 \let> = \ptexgtr
3294 \let+ = \ptexplus
3295 \let' = \ptexquoteright
3299 % for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript.
3300 % If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch
3301 % into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the
3302 % one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not
3303 % fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices.
3305 \def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi}
3306 \def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
3308 \def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi}
3309 \def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\switchtolllsize #1}}$}%
3311 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
3312 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
3313 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
3315 \def\outfmtnametex{tex}
3317 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
3318 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
3319 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
3320 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
3323 % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
3324 % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
3325 \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
3326 \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
3327 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
3328 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
3331 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
3332 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
3333 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
3334 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
3335 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
3336 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
3337 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
3339 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
3340 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
3341 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
3342 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
3343 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
3344 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
3347 % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
3349 \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
3350 \long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
3351 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
3352 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
3353 \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
3356 % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
3358 \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
3359 \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
3360 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
3361 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
3365 \message{glyphs,}
3366 % and logos.
3368 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
3369 \def\@{\char64 }
3370 \let\atchar=\@
3372 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
3373 \def\lbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char123\else\ensuremath\lbrace\fi}}
3374 \def\rbracechar{{\ifmonospace\char125\else\ensuremath\rbrace\fi}}
3375 \let\{=\lbracechar
3376 \let\}=\rbracechar
3378 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
3379 \let\comma = ,
3381 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
3382 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
3383 \let\, = \ptexc
3384 \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
3385 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
3386 \let\tieaccent = \ptext
3387 \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
3388 \let\udotaccent = \d
3390 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
3391 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
3392 \def\questiondown{?`}
3393 \def\exclamdown{!`}
3394 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{a}}}
3395 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize \underbar{o}}}
3397 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
3398 \def\imacro{i}
3399 \def\jmacro{j}
3400 \def\dotless#1{%
3401 \def\temp{#1}%
3402 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
3403 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
3404 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
3405 \fi\fi
3408 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
3409 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
3411 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
3413 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
3414 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
3415 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
3416 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
3417 % \scriptscriptstyle).
3419 \def\LaTeX{%
3420 L\kern-.36em
3421 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
3422 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
3423 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
3424 % for 10pt running text, lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
3425 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
3426 \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
3427 \else
3428 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
3429 \switchtolllsize A%
3432 \vss
3434 \kern-.15em
3435 \TeX
3438 % Some math mode symbols. Define \ensuremath to switch into math mode
3439 % unless we are already there. Expansion tricks may not be needed here,
3440 % but safer, and can't hurt.
3441 \def\ensuremath{\ifmmode \expandafter\asis \else\expandafter\ensuredmath \fi}
3442 \def\ensuredmath#1{$\relax#1$}
3444 \def\bullet{\ensuremath\ptexbullet}
3445 \def\geq{\ensuremath\ge}
3446 \def\leq{\ensuremath\le}
3447 \def\minus{\ensuremath-}
3449 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
3450 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
3451 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
3452 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
3453 % whichever is larger.
3455 \def\dots{%
3456 \leavevmode
3457 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
3458 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
3459 \dimen0 = \wd0
3460 \else
3461 \dimen0 = 1.5em
3463 \hbox to \dimen0{%
3464 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
3465 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3466 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3467 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
3471 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
3473 \def\enddots{%
3474 \dots
3475 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
3478 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
3480 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
3481 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
3483 \def\point{$\star$}
3484 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
3485 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
3486 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
3487 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
3488 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
3490 % The @error{} command.
3491 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3493 \newbox\errorbox
3495 {\ttfont \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
3496 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
3497 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3498 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
3500 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
3501 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
3502 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
3503 \vbox{%
3504 \hrule height\dimen2
3505 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3506 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
3507 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
3508 \hrule height\dimen2}
3509 \hfil}
3511 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
3513 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3515 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
3517 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3518 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3519 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3520 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3521 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3523 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3524 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3525 % font height.
3527 % feymr - regular
3528 % feymo - slanted
3529 % feybr - bold
3530 % feybo - bold slanted
3532 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3533 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3534 % Hmm.
3536 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3537 % Hope not.
3540 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
3541 \def\eurofont{%
3542 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3543 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3544 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3545 % font installed.
3547 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3548 % that to the current nominal size.
3550 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3551 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3553 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3555 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3556 % bold:
3557 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
3558 \else
3559 % regular:
3560 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
3562 \thiseurofont
3565 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3566 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3567 % the redefinition.
3569 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3570 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
3571 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
3572 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
3573 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
3575 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
3576 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3577 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
3578 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3579 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
3580 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
3581 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
3582 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
3584 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3585 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3586 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3587 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3589 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3590 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3591 % the same EC font.
3592 \def\ogonek#1{{%
3593 \def\temp{#1}%
3594 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3595 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3596 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3597 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3598 \else
3599 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
3600 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
3601 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
3603 \fi\fi\fi\fi
3606 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
3607 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
3608 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
3609 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
3611 % Use the European Computer Modern fonts (cm-super in outline format)
3612 % for non-CM glyphs. That is ec* for regular text and tc* for the text
3613 % companion symbols (LaTeX TS1 encoding). Both are part of the ec
3614 % package and follow the same conventions.
3616 \def\ecfont{\etcfont{e}}
3617 \def\tcfont{\etcfont{t}}
3619 \def\etcfont#1{%
3620 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3621 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3622 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3623 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3624 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
3625 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3626 \ifmonospace
3627 % typewriter:
3628 \font\thisecfont = #1ctt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3629 \else
3630 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3631 % bold:
3632 \font\thisecfont = #1cb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3633 \else
3634 % regular:
3635 \font\thisecfont = #1c\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3638 \thisecfont
3641 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3642 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3643 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3645 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3646 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\switchtolllsize R}%
3647 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
3651 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3653 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
3655 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3656 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3657 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3659 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3660 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3663 % Quotes.
3664 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
3665 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3666 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3667 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3670 \message{page headings,}
3672 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
3673 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
3675 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3676 \newif\ifseenauthor
3677 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3679 % @setcontentsaftertitlepage used to do an implicit @contents or
3680 % @shortcontents after @end titlepage, but it is now obsolete.
3681 \def\setcontentsaftertitlepage{%
3682 \errmessage{@setcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
3683 command; move your @contents command if you want the contents
3684 after the title page.}}%
3685 \def\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage{%
3686 \errmessage{@setshortcontentsaftertitlepage has been removed as a Texinfo
3687 command; move your @shortcontents and @contents commands if you
3688 want the contents after the title page.}}%
3690 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3691 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3692 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3694 \envdef\titlepage{%
3695 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3696 \begingroup
3697 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
3698 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3699 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3700 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3701 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3703 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3704 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3705 \let\oldpage = \page
3706 \def\page{%
3707 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3708 \finishtitlepage
3710 \let\page = \oldpage
3711 \page
3712 \null
3716 \def\Etitlepage{%
3717 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3718 \finishtitlepage
3720 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3721 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3722 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3723 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3724 \oldpage
3725 \endgroup
3727 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3728 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3729 \HEADINGSon
3732 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3733 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
3734 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3735 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3738 % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
3739 % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
3740 % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. \par should
3741 % be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
3743 \def\raggedtitlesettings{%
3745 \hyphenpenalty=10000
3746 \parindent=0pt
3747 \tolerance=5000
3748 \ptexraggedright
3751 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3753 \let\subtitlerm=\rmfont
3754 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
3756 \parseargdef\title{%
3757 \checkenv\titlepage
3758 \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
3759 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3760 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3761 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
3764 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3765 \checkenv\titlepage
3766 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3769 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3770 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3772 \parseargdef\author{%
3773 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3774 \ifx\thisenv\temp
3775 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3776 \else
3777 \checkenv\titlepage
3778 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
3779 {\secfonts\rm \leftline{#1}}%
3784 % Set up page headings and footings.
3786 \let\thispage=\folio
3788 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3789 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3790 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3791 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3793 % Now make \makeheadline and \makefootline in Plain TeX use those variables
3794 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3795 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3796 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3797 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3798 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
3800 % Commands to set those variables.
3801 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3802 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3803 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3804 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3805 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3808 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3809 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3810 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3811 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3813 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3814 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3815 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3816 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3818 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3820 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3821 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3822 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3823 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3825 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3826 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3827 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3828 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3830 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3831 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3832 \global\advance\txipageheight by -12pt
3833 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
3836 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3838 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3839 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3841 % The same set of arguments for:
3843 % @oddheadingmarks
3844 % @evenfootingmarks
3845 % @oddfootingmarks
3846 % @everyheadingmarks
3847 % @everyfootingmarks
3849 % These define \getoddheadingmarks, \getevenheadingmarks,
3850 % \getoddfootingmarks, and \getevenfootingmarks, each to one of
3851 % \gettopheadingmarks, \getbottomheadingmarks.
3853 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
3854 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
3855 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
3856 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
3857 \parseargdef\everyheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
3858 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
3859 \parseargdef\everyfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
3860 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
3861 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3862 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3863 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
3864 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
3867 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3868 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3870 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3871 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3872 % @headings off turns them off.
3873 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3874 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3875 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3876 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3877 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3878 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3880 \parseargdef\headings{\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
3882 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3883 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
3884 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
3887 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3888 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3890 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3891 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3892 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3893 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3894 % edge of all pages.
3895 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3896 \global\pageno=1
3897 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3898 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3899 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3900 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3901 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3903 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3905 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3906 % page number on top right.
3907 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3908 \global\pageno=1
3909 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3910 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3911 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3912 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3913 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3915 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3917 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3918 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3919 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3920 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3921 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3922 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3923 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3924 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3927 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3928 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3929 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3930 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3931 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3932 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapterheading\hfil\folio}}
3933 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3936 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3937 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3938 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3939 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3940 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3941 \def\today{%
3942 \number\day\space
3943 \ifcase\month
3944 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3945 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3946 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3948 \space\number\year}
3951 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3952 % It generates no output of its own.
3953 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3954 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3957 \message{tables,}
3958 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3960 % default indentation of table text
3961 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3962 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3963 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3964 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3965 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3967 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3968 \newdimen\itemmax
3970 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3971 % these defs.
3972 % They also define \itemindex
3973 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3975 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3977 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3979 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3980 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3982 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3983 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3984 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3985 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3986 \itemindex{#1}%
3987 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3989 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3990 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3991 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3992 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3993 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3994 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3996 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3997 % but leave it ragged-right.
3998 \begingroup
3999 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
4000 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
4001 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
4002 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
4003 \endgroup
4005 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
4006 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
4007 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
4009 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
4010 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
4011 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
4012 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
4013 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
4014 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
4016 \penalty 10001
4017 \endgroup
4018 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
4019 \else
4020 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
4021 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
4022 \noindent
4023 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
4024 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
4025 % eventually be printed.
4026 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
4027 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
4028 \unhbox0
4029 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
4030 \endgroup
4031 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
4035 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
4036 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
4038 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
4039 \envdef\table{%
4040 \let\itemindex\gobble
4041 \tablecheck{table}%
4043 \envdef\ftable{%
4044 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
4045 \tablecheck{ftable}%
4047 \envdef\vtable{%
4048 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
4049 \tablecheck{vtable}%
4051 \def\tablecheck#1{%
4052 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
4053 \endgroup
4054 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
4055 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
4056 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
4057 \else
4058 \let\next\tablex
4060 \next
4062 \def\tablex#1{%
4063 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
4064 \parsearg\tabley
4066 \def\tabley#1{%
4068 \makevalueexpandable
4069 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
4070 \expandafter
4071 }\temp \endtablez
4073 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
4074 \aboveenvbreak
4075 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
4076 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
4077 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
4078 \itemmax=\tableindent
4079 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
4080 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
4081 \exdentamount=\tableindent
4082 \parindent = 0pt
4083 \parskip = \smallskipamount
4084 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
4085 \let\item = \internalBitem
4086 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
4088 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
4089 \let\Eftable\Etable
4090 \let\Evtable\Etable
4091 \let\Eitemize\Etable
4092 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
4094 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
4096 \newcount \itemno
4098 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
4100 \def\doitemize#1{%
4101 \aboveenvbreak
4102 \itemmax=\itemindent
4103 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
4104 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
4105 \exdentamount=\itemindent
4106 \parindent=0pt
4107 \parskip=\smallskipamount
4108 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
4110 % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
4111 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
4112 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
4113 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
4114 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
4115 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
4116 \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
4118 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
4119 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
4121 \let\item=\itemizeitem
4124 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
4126 \def\itemizeitem{%
4127 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
4128 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
4130 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
4131 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
4132 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
4133 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
4134 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
4135 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
4136 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
4137 % that's the theory.
4138 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
4139 \noindent
4140 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
4142 \ifinner\else
4143 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}% not good to break after first line of item.
4145 % We can be in inner vertical mode in a footnote, although an
4146 % @itemize looks awful there.
4148 \flushcr
4151 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
4152 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
4154 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
4156 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
4157 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
4158 % argument is the same as `1'.
4160 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
4161 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
4162 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
4163 \def\thearg{#1}%
4164 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
4166 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
4167 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
4168 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
4169 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
4170 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
4171 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
4172 \ifx\rest\empty
4173 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
4174 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
4175 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
4176 % not equal to itself.
4177 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
4179 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
4180 % continuing to look for a <number>.
4182 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
4183 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
4184 \else
4185 % It's a letter.
4186 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
4187 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
4188 \else
4189 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
4192 \else
4193 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
4194 \numericenumerate
4198 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
4199 % given in \thearg.
4201 \def\numericenumerate{%
4202 \itemno = \thearg
4203 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
4206 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
4207 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
4208 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
4209 \startenumeration{%
4210 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
4211 \ifnum\itemno=0
4212 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
4213 alphabet}%
4215 \char\lccode\itemno
4219 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
4220 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
4221 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
4222 \startenumeration{%
4223 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
4224 \ifnum\itemno=0
4225 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
4226 alphabet}
4228 \char\uccode\itemno
4232 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
4233 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
4234 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
4236 \def\startenumeration#1{%
4237 \advance\itemno by -1
4238 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
4241 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
4242 % to @enumerate.
4244 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
4245 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
4246 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
4247 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
4250 % @multitable macros
4251 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
4253 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
4254 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
4255 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
4256 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
4258 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
4260 % To make preamble:
4262 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
4263 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
4264 % @item ...
4266 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
4267 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
4268 % columns as desired.
4271 % Or use a template:
4272 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
4273 % @item ...
4274 % using the widest term desired in each column.
4276 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
4277 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
4278 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
4279 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
4281 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
4282 % if they are.
4284 % Sample multitable:
4286 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
4287 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
4288 % @item
4289 % first col stuff
4290 % @tab
4291 % second col stuff
4292 % @tab
4293 % third col
4294 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
4295 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
4297 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
4298 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
4299 % @end multitable
4301 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
4302 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
4303 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
4304 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
4305 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
4306 % to baseline.
4307 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
4309 \newskip\multitableparskip
4310 \newskip\multitableparindent
4311 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
4312 \newskip\multitablelinespace
4313 \multitableparskip=0pt
4314 \multitableparindent=6pt
4315 \multitablecolspace=12pt
4316 \multitablelinespace=0pt
4318 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
4320 \let\endsetuptable\relax
4321 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
4322 \let\columnfractions\relax
4323 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
4324 \newif\ifsetpercent
4326 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
4327 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
4329 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
4330 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4331 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
4332 \setuptable
4335 \newcount\colcount
4336 \def\setuptable#1{%
4337 \def\firstarg{#1}%
4338 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
4339 \let\go = \relax
4340 \else
4341 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
4342 \global\setpercenttrue
4343 \else
4344 \ifsetpercent
4345 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
4346 \else
4347 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4348 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
4349 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
4350 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
4353 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
4354 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
4355 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
4356 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
4357 \else
4358 \let\go = \setuptable
4359 \fi%
4364 % multitable-only commands.
4366 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments
4367 % have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an
4368 % alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to
4369 % undo it ourselves.
4370 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
4371 \def\headitem{%
4372 \checkenv\multitable
4373 \crcr
4374 \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings
4375 \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
4376 \the\everytab % for the first item
4379 % default for tables with no headings.
4380 \let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4382 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
4383 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
4384 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
4385 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
4386 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
4388 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
4390 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
4392 \envdef\multitable{%
4393 \vskip\parskip
4394 \startsavinginserts
4396 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
4397 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
4398 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
4399 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
4400 \def\item{\crcr}%
4402 \tolerance=9500
4403 \hbadness=9500
4404 \setmultitablespacing
4405 \parskip=\multitableparskip
4406 \parindent=\multitableparindent
4407 \overfullrule=0pt
4408 \global\colcount=0
4410 \everycr = {%
4411 \noalign{%
4412 \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem.
4413 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
4415 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.:
4416 \checkinserts
4418 % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset:
4419 \headitemcrhook
4420 \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax
4424 \parsearg\domultitable
4426 \def\domultitable#1{%
4427 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
4428 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
4430 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
4431 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
4432 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
4433 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
4434 \halign\bgroup &%
4435 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4436 \multistrut
4437 \vtop{%
4438 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
4439 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
4441 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
4442 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
4443 % the first one.
4445 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
4446 % to the width of each template entry.
4448 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
4449 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
4450 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
4451 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
4453 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
4454 \rightskip=0pt
4455 \ifnum\colcount=1
4456 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
4457 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
4458 \else
4459 \ifsetpercent \else
4460 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
4461 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
4462 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
4464 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
4465 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
4467 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
4468 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
4469 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
4470 % For example:
4471 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
4472 % @item @code{#}
4473 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
4474 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
4475 % marking characters.
4476 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
4477 }\cr
4479 \def\Emultitable{%
4480 \crcr
4481 \egroup % end the \halign
4482 \global\setpercentfalse
4485 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
4486 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
4488 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
4489 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
4490 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
4491 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
4492 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
4493 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
4494 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
4496 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
4497 % table. If not, do nothing.
4498 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
4499 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
4500 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4501 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4502 % than skip between lines in the table.
4503 \fi%
4504 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
4505 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4506 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4507 % than skip between lines in the table.
4508 \fi}
4511 \message{conditionals,}
4513 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
4514 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
4515 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
4516 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4517 % attempt to close an environment group.
4519 \def\makecond#1{%
4520 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
4521 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
4523 \makecond{iftex}
4524 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
4525 \makecond{ifnothtml}
4526 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
4527 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
4528 \makecond{ifnotxml}
4530 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4532 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
4533 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
4534 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
4535 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
4536 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
4537 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
4538 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
4539 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
4540 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
4541 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
4542 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
4543 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
4544 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
4546 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4548 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4549 \newcount\doignorecount
4551 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4552 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4553 \obeylines
4554 \catcode`\@ = \other
4555 \catcode`\{ = \other
4556 \catcode`\} = \other
4558 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4559 \spaceisspace
4561 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4562 \doignorecount = 0
4564 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4565 \dodoignore{#1}%
4568 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4569 \obeylines %
4571 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4572 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4574 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4575 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
4576 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
4578 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4579 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4580 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4581 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
4583 % And now expand that command.
4584 \doignoretext ^^M%
4588 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4589 \def\temp{#1}%
4590 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4591 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4592 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4593 \advance\doignorecount by 1
4594 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4595 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4597 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4600 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4602 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4603 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4604 \let\next\enddoignore
4605 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4606 \advance\doignorecount by -1
4607 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4609 \next
4612 % Finish off ignored text.
4613 { \obeylines%
4614 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4615 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4616 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4617 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4621 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4622 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4624 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4625 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4626 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4627 % didn't need it.
4628 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4630 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4631 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4633 \makevalueexpandable
4634 \def\temp{#2}%
4635 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
4636 \ifx\temp\empty
4637 \next{}%
4638 \else
4639 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
4643 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4644 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4646 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4648 \parseargdef\clear{%
4650 \makevalueexpandable
4651 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
4655 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4656 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4657 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4659 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
4661 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4662 \let\value = \expandablevalue
4663 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4664 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
4665 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4666 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4667 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4668 \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
4672 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4673 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4674 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4675 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4676 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4677 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4678 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4680 % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
4681 % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
4682 % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
4683 % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
4685 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4686 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4687 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
4688 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
4689 \else
4690 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4694 % Like \expandablevalue, but completely expandable (the \message in the
4695 % definition above operates at the execution level of TeX). Used when
4696 % writing to auxiliary files, due to the expansion that \write does.
4697 % If flag is undefined, pass through an unexpanded @value command: maybe it
4698 % will be set by the time it is read back in.
4700 % NB flag names containing - or _ may not work here.
4701 \def\dummyvalue#1{%
4702 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4703 \noexpand\value{#1}%
4704 \else
4705 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4709 % Used for @value's in index entries to form the sort key: expand the @value
4710 % if possible, otherwise sort late.
4711 \def\indexnofontsvalue#1{%
4712 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4713 ZZZZZZZ
4714 \else
4715 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4719 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4720 % with @set.
4722 % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
4723 % \makecond and then redefine.
4725 \makecond{ifset}
4726 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
4727 \def\doifset#1#2{%
4729 \makevalueexpandable
4730 \let\next=\empty
4731 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
4732 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4734 \expandafter
4735 }\next
4737 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
4739 % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
4740 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4742 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4743 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4744 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4746 \makecond{ifclear}
4747 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
4748 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
4750 % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
4751 % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
4752 % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
4753 % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
4755 \makecond{ifcommanddefined}
4756 \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
4758 \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
4759 \makevalueexpandable
4760 \let\next=\empty
4761 \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
4762 #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
4764 \expandafter
4765 }\next
4767 \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
4769 % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
4770 \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
4771 \def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
4772 \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
4773 \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
4775 % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
4776 % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
4777 \set txicommandconditionals
4779 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4780 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4781 \let\dircategory=\comment
4783 % @defininfoenclose.
4784 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
4787 \message{indexing,}
4788 % Index generation facilities
4790 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4791 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4792 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
4794 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named IX.
4795 % It automatically defines \IXindex such that
4796 % \IXindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index IX.
4797 % It also defines \IXindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4798 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is IX.
4799 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4800 % for the sake of vms.
4802 \def\newindex#1{%
4803 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
4804 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4805 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4808 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4810 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4812 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4814 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4816 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4817 \expandafter\chardef\csname#1indfile\endcsname=0
4818 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
4819 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4822 % The default indices:
4823 \newindex{cp}% concepts,
4824 \newcodeindex{fn}% functions,
4825 \newcodeindex{vr}% variables,
4826 \newcodeindex{tp}% types,
4827 \newcodeindex{ky}% keys
4828 \newcodeindex{pg}% and programs.
4831 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4832 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4834 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4835 % inside @code.
4837 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4838 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4840 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4841 % #3 the target index (bar).
4842 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4843 \requireopenindexfile{#3}%
4844 % redefine \fooindfile:
4845 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
4846 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
4847 % redefine \fooindex:
4848 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4851 % Define \doindex, the driver for all index macros.
4852 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4853 % and it is the two-letter name of the index.
4855 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\doindexxxx}
4856 \def\doindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4858 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4859 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\docodeindexxxx}
4860 \def\docodeindexxxx #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4863 % Used when writing an index entry out to an index file to prevent
4864 % expansion of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4866 \def\indexdummies{%
4867 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
4868 \definedummyletter\@%
4869 \definedummyletter\ %
4871 % For texindex which always views { and } as separators.
4872 \def\{{\lbracechar{}}%
4873 \def\}{\rbracechar{}}%
4875 % Do the redefinitions.
4876 \definedummies
4879 % Used for the aux and toc files, where @ is the escape character.
4881 \def\atdummies{%
4882 \definedummyletter\@%
4883 \definedummyletter\ %
4884 \definedummyletter\{%
4885 \definedummyletter\}%
4887 % Do the redefinitions.
4888 \definedummies
4889 \otherbackslash
4892 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4893 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4894 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4895 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4896 % from whatever follows.
4898 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4899 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4900 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4902 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4903 % space.
4905 \def\definedummyword #1{\def#1{\string#1\space}}%
4906 \def\definedummyletter#1{\def#1{\string#1}}%
4907 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4909 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies, to effectively prevent
4910 % the expansion of commands.
4912 \def\definedummies{%
4914 \let\commondummyword\definedummyword
4915 \let\commondummyletter\definedummyletter
4916 \let\commondummyaccent\definedummyaccent
4917 \commondummiesnofonts
4919 \definedummyletter\_%
4920 \definedummyletter\-%
4922 % Non-English letters.
4923 \definedummyword\AA
4924 \definedummyword\AE
4925 \definedummyword\DH
4926 \definedummyword\L
4927 \definedummyword\O
4928 \definedummyword\OE
4929 \definedummyword\TH
4930 \definedummyword\aa
4931 \definedummyword\ae
4932 \definedummyword\dh
4933 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4934 \definedummyword\l
4935 \definedummyword\o
4936 \definedummyword\oe
4937 \definedummyword\ordf
4938 \definedummyword\ordm
4939 \definedummyword\questiondown
4940 \definedummyword\ss
4941 \definedummyword\th
4943 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4944 \definedummyword\bf
4945 \definedummyword\gtr
4946 \definedummyword\hat
4947 \definedummyword\less
4948 \definedummyword\sf
4949 \definedummyword\sl
4950 \definedummyword\tclose
4951 \definedummyword\tt
4953 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4954 \definedummyword\TeX
4956 % Assorted special characters.
4957 \definedummyword\atchar
4958 \definedummyword\arrow
4959 \definedummyword\bullet
4960 \definedummyword\comma
4961 \definedummyword\copyright
4962 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4963 \definedummyword\dots
4964 \definedummyword\enddots
4965 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4966 \definedummyword\equiv
4967 \definedummyword\error
4968 \definedummyword\euro
4969 \definedummyword\expansion
4970 \definedummyword\geq
4971 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4972 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4973 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4974 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4975 \definedummyword\lbracechar
4976 \definedummyword\leq
4977 \definedummyword\mathopsup
4978 \definedummyword\minus
4979 \definedummyword\ogonek
4980 \definedummyword\pounds
4981 \definedummyword\point
4982 \definedummyword\print
4983 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4984 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4985 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4986 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4987 \definedummyword\quoteright
4988 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4989 \definedummyword\rbracechar
4990 \definedummyword\result
4991 \definedummyword\sub
4992 \definedummyword\sup
4993 \definedummyword\textdegree
4995 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4996 \macrolist
4997 \let\value\dummyvalue
4999 \normalturnoffactive
5002 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \definedummies and \indexnofonts.
5003 % Define \commondummyletter, \commondummyaccent and \commondummyword before
5004 % using. Used for accents, font commands, and various control letters.
5006 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
5007 % Control letters and accents.
5008 \commondummyletter\!%
5009 \commondummyaccent\"%
5010 \commondummyaccent\'%
5011 \commondummyletter\*%
5012 \commondummyaccent\,%
5013 \commondummyletter\.%
5014 \commondummyletter\/%
5015 \commondummyletter\:%
5016 \commondummyaccent\=%
5017 \commondummyletter\?%
5018 \commondummyaccent\^%
5019 \commondummyaccent\`%
5020 \commondummyaccent\~%
5021 \commondummyword\u
5022 \commondummyword\v
5023 \commondummyword\H
5024 \commondummyword\dotaccent
5025 \commondummyword\ogonek
5026 \commondummyword\ringaccent
5027 \commondummyword\tieaccent
5028 \commondummyword\ubaraccent
5029 \commondummyword\udotaccent
5030 \commondummyword\dotless
5032 % Texinfo font commands.
5033 \commondummyword\b
5034 \commondummyword\i
5035 \commondummyword\r
5036 \commondummyword\sansserif
5037 \commondummyword\sc
5038 \commondummyword\slanted
5039 \commondummyword\t
5041 % Commands that take arguments.
5042 \commondummyword\abbr
5043 \commondummyword\acronym
5044 \commondummyword\anchor
5045 \commondummyword\cite
5046 \commondummyword\code
5047 \commondummyword\command
5048 \commondummyword\dfn
5049 \commondummyword\dmn
5050 \commondummyword\email
5051 \commondummyword\emph
5052 \commondummyword\env
5053 \commondummyword\file
5054 \commondummyword\image
5055 \commondummyword\indicateurl
5056 \commondummyword\inforef
5057 \commondummyword\kbd
5058 \commondummyword\key
5059 \commondummyword\math
5060 \commondummyword\option
5061 \commondummyword\pxref
5062 \commondummyword\ref
5063 \commondummyword\samp
5064 \commondummyword\strong
5065 \commondummyword\tie
5066 \commondummyword\U
5067 \commondummyword\uref
5068 \commondummyword\url
5069 \commondummyword\var
5070 \commondummyword\verb
5071 \commondummyword\w
5072 \commondummyword\xref
5075 % For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}.
5076 \newif\ifusebracesinindexes
5078 \let\indexlbrace\relax
5079 \let\indexrbrace\relax
5081 {\catcode`\@=0
5082 \catcode`\\=13
5083 @gdef@backslashdisappear{@def\{}}
5087 \catcode`\<=13
5088 \catcode`\-=13
5089 \catcode`\`=13
5090 \gdef\indexnonalnumdisappear{%
5091 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax\else
5092 % @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us ignore left quotes in the sort term.
5093 % (Introduced for FSFS 2nd ed.)
5094 \let`=\empty
5097 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexbackslashignore\endcsname\relax\else
5098 \backslashdisappear
5101 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexhyphenignore\endcsname\relax\else
5102 \def-{}%
5104 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlessthanignore\endcsname\relax\else
5105 \def<{}%
5107 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexatsignignore\endcsname\relax\else
5108 \def\@{}%
5112 \gdef\indexnonalnumreappear{%
5113 \useindexbackslash
5114 \let-\normaldash
5115 \let<\normalless
5116 \def\@{@}%
5121 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
5122 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
5123 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
5124 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
5126 \def\indexnofonts{%
5127 % Accent commands should become @asis.
5128 \def\commondummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
5129 % We can just ignore other control letters.
5130 \def\commondummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
5131 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
5132 \let\commondummyword\commondummyaccent
5133 \commondummiesnofonts
5135 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
5136 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
5137 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
5138 %\let\tt=\asis
5140 \def\ { }%
5141 \def\@{@}%
5142 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
5143 \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
5145 \uccode`\1=`\{ \uppercase{\def\{{1}}%
5146 \uccode`\1=`\} \uppercase{\def\}{1}}%
5147 \let\lbracechar\{%
5148 \let\rbracechar\}%
5150 % Non-English letters.
5151 \def\AA{AA}%
5152 \def\AE{AE}%
5153 \def\DH{DZZ}%
5154 \def\L{L}%
5155 \def\OE{OE}%
5156 \def\O{O}%
5157 \def\TH{TH}%
5158 \def\aa{aa}%
5159 \def\ae{ae}%
5160 \def\dh{dzz}%
5161 \def\exclamdown{!}%
5162 \def\l{l}%
5163 \def\oe{oe}%
5164 \def\ordf{a}%
5165 \def\ordm{o}%
5166 \def\o{o}%
5167 \def\questiondown{?}%
5168 \def\ss{ss}%
5169 \def\th{th}%
5171 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
5172 \def\TeX{TeX}%
5174 % Assorted special characters. \defglyph gives the control sequence a
5175 % definition that removes the {} that follows its use.
5176 \defglyph\atchar{@}%
5177 \defglyph\arrow{->}%
5178 \defglyph\bullet{bullet}%
5179 \defglyph\comma{,}%
5180 \defglyph\copyright{copyright}%
5181 \defglyph\dots{...}%
5182 \defglyph\enddots{...}%
5183 \defglyph\equiv{==}%
5184 \defglyph\error{error}%
5185 \defglyph\euro{euro}%
5186 \defglyph\expansion{==>}%
5187 \defglyph\geq{>=}%
5188 \defglyph\guillemetleft{<<}%
5189 \defglyph\guillemetright{>>}%
5190 \defglyph\guilsinglleft{<}%
5191 \defglyph\guilsinglright{>}%
5192 \defglyph\leq{<=}%
5193 \defglyph\lbracechar{\{}%
5194 \defglyph\minus{-}%
5195 \defglyph\point{.}%
5196 \defglyph\pounds{pounds}%
5197 \defglyph\print{-|}%
5198 \defglyph\quotedblbase{"}%
5199 \defglyph\quotedblleft{"}%
5200 \defglyph\quotedblright{"}%
5201 \defglyph\quoteleft{`}%
5202 \defglyph\quoteright{'}%
5203 \defglyph\quotesinglbase{,}%
5204 \defglyph\rbracechar{\}}%
5205 \defglyph\registeredsymbol{R}%
5206 \defglyph\result{=>}%
5207 \defglyph\textdegree{o}%
5209 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
5210 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
5211 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
5212 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
5213 % that starts with \.
5215 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
5216 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
5217 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
5219 \macrolist
5220 \let\value\indexnofontsvalue
5222 \def\defglyph#1#2{\def#1##1{#2}} % see above
5227 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
5229 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
5230 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
5231 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
5233 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
5234 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
5235 % TODO: Two-level index? Operation index?
5237 % Workhorse for all indexes.
5238 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
5239 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
5240 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
5242 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
5243 \iflinks
5245 \requireopenindexfile{#1}%
5246 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
5247 \toks0 = {#2}%
5248 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
5249 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
5250 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
5251 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
5254 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
5256 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
5261 % Check if an index file has been opened, and if not, open it.
5262 \def\requireopenindexfile#1{%
5263 \ifnum\csname #1indfile\endcsname=0
5264 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
5265 \edef\suffix{#1}%
5266 % A .fls suffix would conflict with the file extension for the output
5267 % of -recorder, so use .f1s instead.
5268 \ifx\suffix\indexisfl\def\suffix{f1}\fi
5269 % Open the file
5270 \immediate\openout\csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.\suffix
5271 % Using \immediate above here prevents an object entering into the current
5272 % box, which could confound checks such as those in \safewhatsit for
5273 % preceding skips.
5274 \typeout{Writing index file \jobname.\suffix}%
5275 \fi}
5276 \def\indexisfl{fl}
5278 % Output \ as {\indexbackslash}, because \ is an escape character in
5279 % the index files.
5280 \let\indexbackslash=\relax
5281 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
5282 @gdef@useindexbackslash{@def\{{@indexbackslash}}}
5285 % Definition for writing index entry text.
5286 \def\sortas#1{\ignorespaces}%
5288 % Definition for writing index entry sort key. Should occur at the at
5289 % the beginning of the index entry, like
5290 % @cindex @sortas{september} \september
5291 % The \ignorespaces takes care of following space, but there's no way
5292 % to remove space before it.
5294 \catcode`\-=13
5295 \gdef\indexwritesortas{%
5296 \begingroup
5297 \indexnonalnumreappear
5298 \indexwritesortasxxx}
5299 \gdef\indexwritesortasxxx#1{%
5300 \xdef\indexsortkey{#1}\endgroup}
5304 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file.
5306 \def\dosubindwrite{%
5307 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
5308 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
5309 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
5312 % Remember, we are within a group.
5313 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
5314 \useindexbackslash % \indexbackslash isn't defined now so it will be output
5315 % as is; and it will print as backslash.
5316 % The braces around \indexbrace are recognized by texindex.
5318 % Get the string to sort by, by processing the index entry with all
5319 % font commands turned off.
5320 {\indexnofonts
5321 \def\lbracechar{{\indexlbrace}}%
5322 \def\rbracechar{{\indexrbrace}}%
5323 \let\{=\lbracechar
5324 \let\}=\rbracechar
5325 \indexnonalnumdisappear
5326 \xdef\indexsortkey{}%
5327 \let\sortas=\indexwritesortas
5328 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}%
5329 \setbox\dummybox = \hbox{\temp}% Make sure to execute any \sortas
5330 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty
5331 \xdef\indexsortkey{\temp}%
5332 \ifx\indexsortkey\empty\xdef\indexsortkey{ }\fi
5336 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
5337 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
5338 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
5339 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
5340 % sorted result.
5341 \edef\temp{%
5342 \write\writeto{%
5343 \string\entry{\indexsortkey}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
5345 \temp
5347 \newbox\dummybox % used above
5349 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
5351 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
5352 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
5353 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
5354 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
5355 % sequences like this:
5356 % @end defun
5357 % @tindex whatever
5358 % @defun ...
5359 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
5360 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
5361 % the previous defun.
5363 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
5364 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
5366 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
5368 % But wait, there is a catch there:
5369 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
5370 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
5371 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
5372 % representation of the skip.
5374 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
5375 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
5377 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
5379 \newskip\whatsitskip
5380 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
5382 % ..., ready, GO:
5384 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
5386 \else
5387 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
5388 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
5389 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
5390 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
5392 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
5393 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
5394 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
5395 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
5396 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
5397 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5398 \else
5399 \vskip-\whatsitskip
5404 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
5405 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
5406 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
5407 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
5408 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
5409 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
5410 % @deffn deffn-whatever
5411 % @vindex index-whatever
5412 % Description.
5413 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
5414 % and the "Description." paragraph.
5415 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
5416 \else
5417 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
5418 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
5419 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
5420 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
5422 \fi}
5424 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
5425 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
5426 % or
5427 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
5428 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
5429 % containing these kinds of lines:
5430 % \initial {c}
5431 % before the first topic whose initial is c
5432 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
5433 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
5434 % \primary {topic}
5435 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
5436 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
5437 % for each subtopic.
5439 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
5440 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
5442 \def\findex {\fnindex}
5443 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
5444 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
5445 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
5446 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
5447 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
5449 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
5450 {\obeylines %
5451 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
5452 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
5454 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
5456 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
5457 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
5459 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
5460 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
5462 \smallfonts \rm
5463 \tolerance = 9500
5464 \plainfrenchspacing
5465 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
5467 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
5468 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
5469 % \initial {@}
5470 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
5471 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
5472 \catcode`\@ = 12
5473 % See comment in \requireopenindexfile.
5474 \def\indexname{#1}\ifx\indexname\indexisfl\def\indexname{f1}\fi
5475 \openin 1 \jobname.\indexname s
5476 \ifeof 1
5477 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
5478 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
5479 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
5480 % there is some text.
5481 \putwordIndexNonexistent
5482 \typeout{No file \jobname.\indexname s.}%
5483 \else
5484 \catcode`\\ = 0
5486 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
5487 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
5488 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
5489 \read 1 to \thisline
5490 \ifeof 1
5491 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
5492 \else
5493 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
5494 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
5495 % to make right now.
5496 \def\indexbackslash{\ttbackslash}%
5497 \let\indexlbrace\{ % Likewise, set these sequences for braces
5498 \let\indexrbrace\} % used in the sort key.
5499 \begindoublecolumns
5500 \let\entrywidowpenalty=\indexwidowpenalty
5502 % Read input from the index file line by line.
5503 \loopdo
5504 \ifeof1
5505 \let\firsttoken\relax
5506 \else
5507 \read 1 to \nextline
5508 \edef\act{\gdef\noexpand\firsttoken{\getfirsttoken\nextline}}%
5509 \act
5511 \thisline
5513 \ifeof1\else
5514 \let\thisline\nextline
5515 \repeat
5517 \enddoublecolumns
5520 \closein 1
5521 \endgroup}
5523 \def\getfirsttoken#1{\expandafter\getfirsttokenx#1\endfirsttoken}
5524 \long\def\getfirsttokenx#1#2\endfirsttoken{\noexpand#1}
5526 \def\loopdo#1\repeat{\def\body{#1}\loopdoxxx}
5527 \def\loopdoxxx{\let\next=\relax\body\let\next=\loopdoxxx\fi\next}
5529 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
5530 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
5532 {\catcode`\/=13 \catcode`\-=13 \catcode`\^=13 \catcode`\~=13 \catcode`\_=13
5533 \catcode`\|=13 \catcode`\<=13 \catcode`\>=13 \catcode`\+=13 \catcode`\"=13
5534 \catcode`\$=3
5535 \gdef\initialglyphs{%
5536 % Some changes for non-alphabetic characters. Using the glyphs from the
5537 % math fonts looks more consistent than the typewriter font used elsewhere
5538 % for these characters.
5539 \def\indexbackslash{\math{\backslash}}%
5540 \let\\=\indexbackslash
5542 % Can't get bold backslash so don't use bold forward slash
5543 \catcode`\/=13
5544 \def/{{\secrmnotbold \normalslash}}%
5545 \def-{{\normaldash\normaldash}}% en dash `--'
5546 \def^{{\chapbf \normalcaret}}%
5547 \def~{{\chapbf \normaltilde}}%
5548 \def\_{%
5549 \leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }%
5550 \def|{$\vert$}%
5551 \def<{$\less$}%
5552 \def>{$\gtr$}%
5553 \def+{$\normalplus$}%
5556 \def\initial{%
5557 \bgroup
5558 \initialglyphs
5559 \initialx
5562 \def\initialx#1{%
5563 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
5564 \removelastskip
5566 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
5567 % The glue before the bonus allows a little bit of space at the
5568 % bottom of a column to reduce an increase in inter-line spacing.
5569 \nobreak
5570 \vskip 0pt plus 5\baselineskip
5571 \penalty -300
5572 \vskip 0pt plus -5\baselineskip
5574 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
5575 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
5576 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
5577 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
5579 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
5580 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus 1\baselineskip
5581 \leftline{\secfonts \kern-0.05em \secbf #1}%
5582 % \secfonts is inside the argument of \leftline so that the change of
5583 % \baselineskip will not affect any glue inserted before the vbox that
5584 % \leftline creates.
5585 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
5586 \nobreak
5587 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
5588 \egroup % \initialglyphs
5591 \newdimen\entryrightmargin
5592 \entryrightmargin=0pt
5594 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
5595 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
5596 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
5598 \def\entry{%
5599 \begingroup
5601 % For pdfTeX and XeTeX.
5602 % The redefinition of \domark stops marks being added in \pdflink to
5603 % preserve coloured links across page boundaries. Otherwise the marks
5604 % would get in the way of \lastbox in \insertindexentrybox.
5605 \let\domark\relax
5607 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
5608 % affect previous text.
5609 \par
5611 % No extra space above this paragraph.
5612 \parskip = 0in
5614 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
5615 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
5616 % titles, for instance.
5617 \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5618 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% An undocumented command
5620 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
5621 \afterassignment\doentry
5622 \let\temp =
5624 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5625 \def\doentry{%
5626 % Save the text of the entry
5627 \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup
5628 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
5629 \noindent
5630 \aftergroup\finishentry
5631 % And now comes the text of the entry.
5632 % Not absorbing as a macro argument reduces the chance of problems
5633 % with catcodes occurring.
5635 {\catcode`\@=11
5636 \gdef\finishentry#1{%
5637 \egroup % end box A
5638 \dimen@ = \wd\boxA % Length of text of entry
5639 \global\setbox\boxA=\hbox\bgroup\unhbox\boxA
5640 % #1 is the page number.
5642 % Get the width of the page numbers, and only use
5643 % leaders if they are present.
5644 \global\setbox\boxB = \hbox{#1}%
5645 \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
5646 \null\nobreak\hfill\ %
5647 \else
5649 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
5651 \ifpdf
5652 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5653 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5654 \else
5655 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
5656 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable #1%
5657 \else
5658 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5659 \hskip\skip\thinshrinkable\the\toksA
5663 \egroup % end \boxA
5664 \ifdim\wd\boxB = 0pt
5665 \global\setbox\entryindexbox=\vbox{\unhbox\boxA}%
5666 \else
5667 \global\setbox\entryindexbox=\vbox\bgroup
5668 % We want the text of the entries to be aligned to the left, and the
5669 % page numbers to be aligned to the right.
5671 \parindent = 0pt
5672 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fil
5673 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus -1fill
5674 \rightskip = 0pt plus -1fil
5675 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fill
5676 % Cause last line, which could consist of page numbers on their own
5677 % if the list of page numbers is long, to be aligned to the right.
5678 \parfillskip=0pt plus -1fill
5680 \advance\rightskip by \entryrightmargin
5681 % Determine how far we can stretch into the margin.
5682 % This allows, e.g., "Appendix H GNU Free Documentation License" to
5683 % fit on one line in @letterpaper format.
5684 \ifdim\entryrightmargin>2.1em
5685 \dimen@i=2.1em
5686 \else
5687 \dimen@i=0em
5689 \advance \parfillskip by 0pt minus 1\dimen@i
5691 \dimen@ii = \hsize
5692 \advance\dimen@ii by -1\leftskip
5693 \advance\dimen@ii by -1\entryrightmargin
5694 \advance\dimen@ii by 1\dimen@i
5695 \ifdim\wd\boxA > \dimen@ii % If the entry doesn't fit in one line
5696 \ifdim\dimen@ > 0.8\dimen@ii % due to long index text
5697 \dimen@ = 0.7\dimen@ % Try to split the text roughly evenly
5698 \dimen@ii = \hsize
5699 \ifnum\dimen@>\dimen@ii
5700 % If the entry is too long, use the whole line
5701 \dimen@ = \dimen@ii
5703 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill % ragged right
5704 \advance \dimen@ by 1\rightskip
5705 \parshape = 2 0pt \dimen@ 0em \dimen@ii
5706 % Ideally we'd add a finite glue at the end of the first line only,
5707 % instead of using \parshape with explicit line lengths, but TeX
5708 % doesn't seem to provide a way to do such a thing.
5710 \leftskip = 1em
5711 \parindent = -1em
5712 \fi\fi
5713 \indent % start paragraph
5714 \unhbox\boxA
5716 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
5717 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
5719 % Word spacing - no stretch
5720 \spaceskip=\fontdimen2\font minus \fontdimen4\font
5722 \linepenalty=1000 % Discourage line breaks.
5723 \hyphenpenalty=5000 % Discourage hyphenation.
5725 \par % format the paragraph
5726 \egroup % The \vbox
5728 \endgroup
5729 % delay text of entry until after penalty
5730 \bgroup\aftergroup\insertindexentrybox
5731 \entrywidowpenalty
5734 \newskip\thinshrinkable
5735 \skip\thinshrinkable=.15em minus .15em
5737 \newbox\entryindexbox
5738 \def\insertindexentrybox{%
5739 \ourunvbox\entryindexbox
5742 % Use \lastbox to take apart vbox box by box, and add each sub-box
5743 % to the current vertical list.
5744 \def\ourunvbox#1{%
5745 \bgroup % for local binding of \delayedbox
5746 % Remove the last box from box #1
5747 \global\setbox#1=\vbox{%
5748 \unvbox#1%
5749 \unskip % remove any glue
5750 \unpenalty
5751 \global\setbox\interbox=\lastbox
5753 \setbox\delayedbox=\box\interbox
5754 \ifdim\ht#1=0pt\else
5755 \ourunvbox#1 % Repeat on what's left of the box
5756 \nobreak
5758 \box\delayedbox
5759 \egroup
5761 \newbox\delayedbox
5762 \newbox\interbox
5764 % Default is no penalty
5765 \let\entrywidowpenalty\egroup
5767 % Used from \printindex. \firsttoken should be the first token
5768 % after the \entry. If it's not another \entry, we are at the last
5769 % line of a group of index entries, so insert a penalty to discourage
5770 % widowed index entries.
5771 \long\def\indexwidowpenalty{%
5772 \def\isentry{\entry}%
5773 \ifx\firsttoken\isentry
5774 \else
5775 \penalty 9000
5777 \egroup % now comes the box added with \aftergroup
5780 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
5781 % The filll stretch here overpowers both the fil and fill stretch to push
5782 % the page number to the right.
5783 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
5784 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1filll}
5787 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
5789 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
5790 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
5791 \parfillskip=0in
5792 \parskip=0in
5793 \hangindent=1in
5794 \hangafter=1
5795 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
5796 \ifpdf
5797 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5798 \else
5799 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
5801 \else
5802 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5805 \par
5808 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5809 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5810 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5811 \catcode`\@=11 % private names
5813 \newbox\partialpage
5814 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5816 % Use inside an output routine to save \topmark and \firstmark
5817 \def\savemarks{%
5818 \global\savedtopmark=\expandafter{\topmark }%
5819 \global\savedfirstmark=\expandafter{\firstmark }%
5821 \newtoks\savedtopmark
5822 \newtoks\savedfirstmark
5824 % Set \topmark and \firstmark for next time \output runs.
5825 % Can't be run from withinside \output (because any material
5826 % added while an output routine is active, including
5827 % penalties, is saved for after it finishes). The page so far
5828 % should be empty, otherwise what's on it will be thrown away.
5829 \def\restoremarks{%
5830 \mark{\the\savedtopmark}%
5831 \bgroup\output = {%
5832 \setbox\dummybox=\box\PAGE
5833 }abc\eject\egroup
5834 % "abc" because output routine doesn't fire for a completely empty page.
5835 \mark{\the\savedfirstmark}%
5838 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5839 % If not much space left on page, start a new page.
5840 \ifdim\pagetotal>0.8\vsize\vfill\eject\fi
5842 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5843 \output = {%
5845 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5846 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5847 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5848 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5849 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5850 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5851 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5852 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5853 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5856 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
5857 % Unvbox the main output page.
5858 \unvbox\PAGE
5859 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5861 \savemarks
5863 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5864 \restoremarks
5866 % We recover the two marks that the last output routine saved in order
5867 % to propagate the information in marks added around a chapter heading,
5868 % which could be otherwise be lost by the time the final page is output.
5871 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5872 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
5874 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5875 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5876 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5877 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5878 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5880 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5881 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5882 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5883 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5884 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5886 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5887 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5888 % been clobbered.
5890 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
5891 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
5892 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
5893 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5895 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
5896 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
5897 \vsize = 2\vsize
5899 % For the benefit of balancing columns
5900 \advance\baselineskip by 0pt plus 0.5pt
5903 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5904 % the last, which is done by \balancecolumns.
5906 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5908 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
5909 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5910 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5911 % previous page.
5912 \dimen@ = \vsize
5913 \divide\dimen@ by 2
5914 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
5916 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5917 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
5918 \onepageout\pagesofar
5919 \unvbox255
5920 \penalty\outputpenalty
5923 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5924 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5925 \def\pagesofar{%
5926 \unvbox\partialpage
5928 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5929 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
5930 \hbox to\txipagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
5934 % Finished with with double columns.
5935 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5936 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5937 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5938 % following situation:
5940 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5941 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5942 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5943 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5944 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5945 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5946 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5947 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5948 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5949 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5950 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5951 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5952 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5953 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5954 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5955 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5956 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5957 % and the final section into the vbox of \txipageheight (see
5958 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5960 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5961 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5962 \penalty0
5964 \output = {%
5965 % Split the last of the double-column material.
5966 \savemarks
5967 \balancecolumns
5969 % Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5970 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5971 % definition right away.
5972 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5974 \eject
5975 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5976 \restoremarks
5977 % Leave the double-column material on the current page, no automatic
5978 % page break.
5979 \box\balancedcolumns
5981 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5982 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5983 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
5984 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
5985 \pagegoal = \vsize
5987 \newbox\balancedcolumns
5988 \setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{shouldnt see this}%
5990 % Only called for the last of the double column material. \doublecolumnout
5991 % does the others.
5992 \def\balancecolumns{%
5993 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5994 \dimen@ = \ht0
5995 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
5996 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
5997 \ifdim\dimen@<5\baselineskip
5998 % Don't split a short final column in two.
5999 \setbox2=\vbox{}%
6000 \else
6001 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
6002 \dimen@ii = \dimen@
6003 \splittopskip = \topskip
6004 % Loop until left column is at least as high as the right column.
6006 \vbadness = 10000
6007 \loop
6008 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
6009 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
6010 \ifdim\ht1<\ht3
6011 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
6012 \repeat
6014 % Now the left column is in box 1, and the right column in box 3.
6015 % Check whether the left column has come out higher than the page itself.
6016 % (Note that we have doubled \vsize for the double columns, so
6017 % the actual height of the page is 0.5\vsize).
6018 \ifdim2\ht1>\vsize
6019 % Just split the last of the double column material roughly in half.
6020 \setbox2=\box0
6021 \setbox0 = \vsplit2 to \dimen@ii
6022 \setbox0=\vbox to \dimen@ii {\unvbox0\vfill}%
6023 \setbox2=\vbox to \dimen@ii {\unvbox2\vfill}%
6024 \else
6025 % Compare the heights of the two columns.
6026 \ifdim4\ht1>5\ht3
6027 % Column heights are too different, so don't make their bottoms
6028 % flush with each other.
6029 \setbox2=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox3\vfill}%
6030 \setbox0=\vbox to \ht1 {\unvbox1\vfill}%
6031 \else
6032 % Make column bottoms flush with each other.
6033 \setbox2=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox3\unskip}%
6034 \setbox0=\vbox to\ht1{\unvbox1\unskip}%
6039 \global\setbox\balancedcolumns=\vbox{\pagesofar}%
6041 \catcode`\@ = \other
6044 \message{sectioning,}
6045 % Chapters, sections, etc.
6047 % Let's start with @part.
6048 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
6049 \def\partzzz#1{%
6050 \chapoddpage
6051 \null
6052 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
6053 \begingroup
6054 \noindent \titlefonts\rm #1\par % the text
6055 \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
6056 \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
6057 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
6058 % This outputs a mark at the end of the page that clears \thischapter
6059 % and \thissection, as is done in \startcontents.
6060 \let\pchapsepmacro\relax
6061 \chapmacro{}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6062 \chapoddpage
6063 \endgroup
6066 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
6067 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
6068 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
6069 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
6070 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
6071 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
6072 \newcount\chapno
6073 \newcount\secno \secno=0
6074 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
6075 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
6077 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
6078 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
6080 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
6081 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
6082 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
6083 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
6085 \def\appendixletter{%
6086 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
6087 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
6088 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
6089 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
6090 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
6091 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
6092 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
6093 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
6094 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
6095 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
6096 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
6097 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
6098 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
6099 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
6100 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
6101 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
6102 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
6103 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
6104 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
6105 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
6106 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
6107 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
6108 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
6109 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
6110 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
6111 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
6112 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
6113 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
6114 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
6115 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
6116 \else\char\the\appendixno
6117 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
6118 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
6120 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
6121 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
6122 % these. @section does likewise.
6123 \def\thischapter{}
6124 \def\thischapternum{}
6125 \def\thischaptername{}
6126 \def\thissection{}
6127 \def\thissectionnum{}
6128 \def\thissectionname{}
6130 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
6131 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
6133 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
6134 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
6135 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
6137 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
6138 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
6139 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
6141 % we only have subsub.
6142 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
6144 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
6145 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
6146 \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
6148 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
6149 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
6150 \def\chapheadtype{N}
6152 % Choose a heading macro
6153 % #1 is heading type
6154 % #2 is heading level
6155 % #3 is text for heading
6156 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
6157 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
6158 \absseclevel=#2
6159 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
6160 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
6161 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
6162 \absseclevel = 0
6163 \else
6164 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
6165 \absseclevel = 3
6168 % The heading type:
6169 \def\headtype{#1}%
6170 \if \headtype U%
6171 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
6172 \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
6174 \else
6175 % Check for appendix sections:
6176 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
6177 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
6178 \else
6179 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
6180 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
6181 \fi\fi
6183 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
6184 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
6185 \def\headtype{U}%
6186 \else
6187 \chardef\unnlevel = 3
6190 % Now print the heading:
6191 \if \headtype U%
6192 \ifcase\absseclevel
6193 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
6194 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
6195 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
6196 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6198 \else
6199 \if \headtype A%
6200 \ifcase\absseclevel
6201 \appendixzzz{#3}%
6202 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
6203 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
6204 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6206 \else
6207 \ifcase\absseclevel
6208 \chapterzzz{#3}%
6209 \or \seczzz{#3}%
6210 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
6211 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
6215 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
6218 % an interface:
6219 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
6220 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
6221 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
6223 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
6224 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
6226 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
6227 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
6228 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
6230 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
6231 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
6232 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
6233 % as an @include file.
6234 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6235 \global\advance\chapno by 1
6237 % Used for \float.
6238 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
6239 \resetallfloatnos
6241 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
6242 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
6243 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
6245 % Write the actual heading.
6246 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
6248 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
6249 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
6250 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
6251 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
6254 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
6256 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
6257 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6258 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
6259 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
6260 \resetallfloatnos
6262 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
6263 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
6264 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
6266 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
6268 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
6269 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
6270 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
6273 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
6274 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
6275 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
6276 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
6277 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
6279 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
6280 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
6281 \resetallfloatnos
6283 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
6284 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
6285 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
6286 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
6287 % to be executed, not expanded).
6289 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
6290 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
6291 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
6292 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
6293 % the toc entries.)
6294 \toks0 = {#1}%
6295 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
6297 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
6299 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
6300 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
6301 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
6304 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
6305 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
6306 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
6307 \unnmhead0{#1}%
6308 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
6311 % @top is like @unnumbered.
6312 \let\top\unnumbered
6314 % Sections.
6316 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
6317 \def\seczzz#1{%
6318 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6319 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
6322 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
6323 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
6324 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
6325 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6326 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
6328 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
6330 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
6331 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
6332 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
6333 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
6334 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
6337 % Subsections.
6339 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
6340 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
6341 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
6342 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6343 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6346 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
6347 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
6348 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
6349 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6350 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
6351 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6354 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
6355 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
6356 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
6357 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
6358 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
6359 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
6362 % Subsubsections.
6364 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
6365 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
6366 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
6367 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6368 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
6369 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6372 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
6373 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
6374 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
6375 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6376 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
6377 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6380 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
6381 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
6382 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
6383 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
6384 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
6385 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
6388 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
6389 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
6390 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
6391 \let\section = \numberedsec
6392 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
6393 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
6395 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
6397 \def\majorheading{%
6398 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
6399 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
6402 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
6403 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
6404 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
6405 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
6406 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
6409 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
6410 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6411 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6412 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6413 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6414 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
6415 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
6417 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
6418 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
6419 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
6421 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
6422 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
6424 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
6425 \newskip\chapheadingskip
6427 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
6428 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
6430 % Start a new page
6431 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
6433 % \chapoddpage - start on an odd page for a new chapter
6434 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
6435 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
6436 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
6437 \def\chapoddpage{%
6438 \chappager
6439 \ifodd\pageno \else
6440 \begingroup
6441 \headingsoff
6442 \null
6443 \chappager
6444 \endgroup
6448 \parseargdef\setchapternewpage{\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
6450 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
6451 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
6452 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
6453 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
6455 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
6456 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
6457 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
6458 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
6459 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
6461 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
6462 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
6463 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
6464 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
6465 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
6467 \CHAPPAGon
6469 % \chapmacro - Chapter opening.
6471 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
6472 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
6473 % Not used for @heading series.
6475 % To test against our argument.
6476 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
6477 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
6478 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
6480 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
6481 \expandafter\ifx\thisenv\titlepage\else
6482 \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment.
6484 % FIXME: \chapmacro is currently called from inside \titlepage when
6485 % \setcontentsaftertitlepage to print the "Table of Contents" heading, but
6486 % this should probably be done by \sectionheading with an option to print
6487 % in chapter size.
6489 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6490 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
6491 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6492 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6493 \gdef\thissection{}}%
6495 \def\temptype{#2}%
6496 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6497 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6498 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
6499 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6500 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
6501 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
6502 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6503 \toks0={#1}%
6504 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6505 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6506 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
6507 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
6508 % commands in some of the translations.
6509 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
6510 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6511 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6513 \else
6514 \toks0={#1}%
6515 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
6516 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
6517 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
6518 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
6519 % commands in some of the translations.
6520 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
6521 \noexpand\thischapternum:
6522 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
6524 \fi\fi\fi
6526 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6527 % the preceding space.
6528 \safewhatsit\domark
6530 % Insert the chapter heading break.
6531 \pchapsepmacro
6533 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6534 % between here and the heading.
6535 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
6536 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6537 \domark
6540 \chapfonts \rm
6541 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message
6543 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
6544 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
6545 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
6546 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6548 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
6549 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
6550 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6551 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6552 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
6553 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6554 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
6555 \def\toctype{omit}%
6556 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6557 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
6558 \def\toctype{app}%
6559 \else
6560 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
6561 \def\toctype{numchap}%
6562 \fi\fi\fi
6564 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
6565 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
6566 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
6567 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
6569 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
6570 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
6571 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
6572 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
6573 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
6574 \donoderef{#2}%
6576 % Typeset the actual heading.
6577 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
6578 \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
6579 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
6581 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
6582 \nobreak
6585 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
6586 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
6587 \def\centerparameters{%
6588 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
6589 \leftskip = \rightskip
6590 \parfillskip = 0pt
6594 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
6595 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
6597 \newskip\secheadingskip
6598 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
6600 % Subsection titles.
6601 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
6602 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
6604 % Subsubsection titles.
6605 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
6606 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
6609 % Print any size, any type, section title.
6611 % #1 is the text of the title,
6612 % #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec),
6613 % #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc),
6614 % #4 is the section number.
6616 \def\seckeyword{sec}
6618 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
6620 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
6621 \def\temptype{#3}%
6623 % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an
6624 % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is
6625 % dubious), but not the others.
6626 \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else
6627 \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment.
6629 \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading
6631 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
6632 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
6634 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
6635 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6636 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6637 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6638 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
6639 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
6641 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6642 % Don't redefine \thissection.
6643 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6644 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6645 \toks0={#1}%
6646 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6647 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6648 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6649 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6650 % commands in some of the translations.
6651 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6652 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6653 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6656 \else
6657 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
6658 \toks0={#1}%
6659 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
6660 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
6661 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
6662 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
6663 % commands in some of the translations.
6664 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
6665 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
6666 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
6669 \fi\fi\fi
6671 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
6672 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
6673 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
6674 \par
6676 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
6677 % the preceding space.
6678 \safewhatsit\domark
6680 % Insert space above the heading.
6681 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
6683 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
6684 % between here and the heading.
6685 \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
6686 \domark
6688 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
6689 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
6690 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6691 \def\toctype{unn}%
6692 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6693 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
6694 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
6695 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
6696 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
6697 \def\toctype{omit}%
6698 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
6699 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
6700 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6701 \def\toctype{app}%
6702 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6703 \else
6704 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
6705 \def\toctype{num}%
6706 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
6707 \fi\fi\fi
6709 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
6710 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
6712 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
6713 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
6714 \donoderef{#3}%
6716 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
6717 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
6718 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
6719 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
6720 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
6721 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
6722 \nobreak
6724 % Output the actual section heading.
6725 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
6726 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
6727 \unhbox0 #1}%
6729 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
6730 % Don't allow stretch, though.
6731 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
6733 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
6734 % was followed by glue.
6735 \nobreak
6737 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
6738 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
6739 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
6740 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
6741 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
6742 % obscuring the section heading with something else.
6743 \vskip-\parskip
6745 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
6746 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
6747 % and do the needful.
6748 \penalty 10001
6752 \message{toc,}
6753 % Table of contents.
6754 \newwrite\tocfile
6756 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
6757 % Called from @chapter, etc.
6759 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
6760 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
6761 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
6762 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
6763 % destination to jump to.
6765 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
6766 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
6767 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
6768 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
6770 \newif\iftocfileopened
6771 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
6773 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
6774 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
6775 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
6776 \iftocfileopened\else
6777 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
6778 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
6781 \iflinks
6782 {\atdummies
6783 \edef\temp{%
6784 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
6785 \temp
6790 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
6791 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
6792 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
6793 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
6794 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
6795 % `1', and two named `2'.
6796 \ifpdf
6797 \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
6798 \else
6799 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
6800 \else
6801 \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue
6807 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
6808 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
6809 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
6811 \def\activecatcodes{%
6812 \catcode`\"=\active
6813 \catcode`\$=\active
6814 \catcode`\<=\active
6815 \catcode`\>=\active
6816 \catcode`\\=\active
6817 \catcode`\^=\active
6818 \catcode`\_=\active
6819 \catcode`\|=\active
6820 \catcode`\~=\active
6824 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
6825 \def\readtocfile{%
6826 \setupdatafile
6827 \activecatcodes
6828 \input \tocreadfilename
6831 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
6832 \newcount\savepageno
6833 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
6835 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
6837 \def\startcontents#1{%
6838 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
6839 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
6840 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
6841 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
6842 \contentsalignmacro
6843 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
6845 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
6846 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
6847 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6849 \savepageno = \pageno
6850 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
6851 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
6852 \entryrightmargin=\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
6854 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
6855 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
6858 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
6859 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
6861 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
6863 % Normal (long) toc.
6865 \def\contents{%
6866 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
6867 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6868 \ifeof 1 \else
6869 \readtocfile
6871 \vfill \eject
6872 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6873 \ifeof 1 \else
6874 \pdfmakeoutlines
6876 \closein 1
6877 \endgroup
6878 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6879 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6882 % And just the chapters.
6883 \def\summarycontents{%
6884 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6886 \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
6887 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
6888 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
6889 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
6890 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6891 \secfonts
6892 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
6893 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
6895 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
6896 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
6897 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
6898 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
6899 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
6900 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6901 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6902 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6903 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6904 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6905 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6906 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6907 \ifeof 1 \else
6908 \readtocfile
6910 \closein 1
6911 \vfill \eject
6912 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6913 \endgroup
6914 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6915 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6917 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
6919 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6920 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6922 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6923 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6924 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6925 % But use \hss just in case.
6926 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6927 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6929 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6930 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6931 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6932 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6933 % there are before deciding ...
6934 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
6937 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6938 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6939 % The last argument is the page number.
6940 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6942 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6943 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6944 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6945 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
6946 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}}
6948 % Parts, in the short toc.
6949 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6950 \penalty-300
6951 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
6952 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6955 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6956 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6958 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6959 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6960 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6961 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6964 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6965 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6967 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6968 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6969 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
6970 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6972 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\hskip.7em#1}{#4}}
6974 % Unnumbered chapters.
6975 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6976 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6978 % Sections.
6979 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6980 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
6981 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6983 % Subsections.
6984 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6985 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
6986 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6988 % And subsubsections.
6989 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6990 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
6991 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6993 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
6994 % Same as \defaultparindent.
6995 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
6997 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
6998 % page number.
7000 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
7001 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
7002 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
7003 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
7004 \begingroup
7005 % Move the page numbers slightly to the right
7006 \advance\entryrightmargin by -0.05em
7007 \chapentryfonts
7008 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7009 \endgroup
7010 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
7013 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7014 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
7015 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7016 \endgroup}
7018 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7019 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
7020 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7021 \endgroup}
7023 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
7024 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
7025 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
7026 \endgroup}
7028 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
7029 \let\tocentry = \entry
7031 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
7032 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
7034 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
7035 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
7037 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
7038 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
7039 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
7040 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
7043 \message{environments,}
7044 % @foo ... @end foo.
7046 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
7047 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
7048 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
7050 \envdef\tex{%
7051 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
7052 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
7053 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
7054 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
7055 \catcode `\%=14
7056 \catcode `\+=\other
7057 \catcode `\"=\other
7058 \catcode `\|=\other
7059 \catcode `\<=\other
7060 \catcode `\>=\other
7061 \catcode `\`=\other
7062 \catcode `\'=\other
7064 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
7065 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
7066 \mathactive
7068 % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file.
7069 \let\b=\ptexb
7070 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
7071 \let\c=\ptexc
7072 \let\,=\ptexcomma
7073 \let\.=\ptexdot
7074 \let\dots=\ptexdots
7075 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
7076 \let\!=\ptexexclam
7077 \let\i=\ptexi
7078 \let\indent=\ptexindent
7079 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
7080 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
7081 \let\+=\tabalign
7082 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
7083 \let\/=\ptexslash
7084 \let\sp=\ptexsp
7085 \let\*=\ptexstar
7086 %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode
7087 \let\t=\ptext
7088 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
7089 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
7091 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
7092 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
7093 \def\@{@}%
7095 % There is no need to define \Etex.
7097 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
7098 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
7099 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
7101 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
7102 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
7104 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
7105 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
7106 % have any width.
7107 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
7109 % This space is always present above and below environments.
7110 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
7112 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
7113 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
7114 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
7115 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
7117 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
7118 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
7119 % \sectionheading, q.v.
7120 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
7121 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
7122 \endgraf
7123 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
7124 \removelastskip
7125 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
7126 % Penalize breaking before the environment, because preceding text
7127 % often leads into it.
7128 \penalty100
7130 \vskip\envskipamount
7135 \def\afterenvbreak{{%
7136 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
7137 % \sectionheading, q.v.
7138 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
7139 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
7140 \endgraf
7141 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
7142 \removelastskip
7143 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
7144 % or better ...
7145 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
7146 \vskip\envskipamount
7151 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
7152 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
7153 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
7155 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
7156 % environment contents.
7157 \font\circle=lcircle10
7158 \newdimen\circthick
7159 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
7160 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
7161 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
7163 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
7164 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
7165 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
7166 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
7167 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
7168 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
7169 \hskip\rskip}}
7170 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
7171 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
7172 \hskip\rskip}}
7174 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
7176 \envdef\cartouche{%
7177 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
7178 \startsavinginserts
7179 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
7180 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
7181 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
7182 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
7183 \cartouter=\hsize
7184 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
7185 % side, and for 6pt waste from
7186 % each corner char, and rule thickness
7187 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
7189 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
7190 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
7191 % collide with the section heading.
7192 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
7194 \setbox\groupbox=\vbox\bgroup
7195 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
7196 \carttop
7197 \hbox\bgroup
7198 \hskip\lskip
7199 \vrule\kern3pt
7200 \vbox\bgroup
7201 \kern3pt
7202 \hsize=\cartinner
7203 \baselineskip=\normbskip
7204 \lineskip=\normlskip
7205 \parskip=\normpskip
7206 \vskip -\parskip
7207 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
7209 \def\Ecartouche{%
7210 \ifhmode\par\fi
7211 \kern3pt
7212 \egroup
7213 \kern3pt\vrule
7214 \hskip\rskip
7215 \egroup
7216 \cartbot
7217 \egroup
7218 \addgroupbox
7219 \checkinserts
7223 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
7224 % inside a group.
7225 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
7226 \def\nonfillstart{%
7227 \aboveenvbreak
7228 \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
7229 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
7230 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
7231 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
7232 \parskip = 0pt
7233 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
7234 % the normal \indent.
7235 \nonfillparindent=\parindent
7236 \parindent = 0pt
7237 \let\indent\nonfillindent
7239 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
7240 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7241 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
7242 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
7243 \else
7244 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
7246 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
7249 \begingroup
7250 \obeyspaces
7251 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
7252 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
7253 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
7254 % @indent.
7255 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
7256 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
7257 \ifx\temp %
7258 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
7259 \else%
7260 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
7261 \fi%
7263 \endgroup
7264 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
7265 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
7267 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
7268 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
7269 % This affects the following displayed environments:
7270 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
7272 \def\smallword{small}
7273 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
7274 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
7275 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
7276 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
7277 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
7278 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
7279 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
7280 % to change the fonts afterward.
7281 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
7282 \smallexamplefonts \rm
7285 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
7286 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
7287 \else
7288 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
7289 \smallexamplefonts \rm
7293 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
7294 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
7295 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
7296 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
7297 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
7298 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
7299 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
7302 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
7303 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
7304 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
7305 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
7308 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
7309 % @example: same as @lisp.
7311 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
7312 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
7314 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
7315 \nonfillstart
7316 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
7317 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
7318 \gobble % eat return
7320 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
7322 \makedispenvdef{display}{%
7323 \nonfillstart
7324 \gobble
7327 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
7329 \makedispenvdef{format}{%
7330 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7331 \nonfillstart
7332 \gobble
7335 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
7336 \envdef\flushleft{%
7337 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7338 \nonfillstart
7339 \gobble
7341 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
7343 % @flushright.
7345 \envdef\flushright{%
7346 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7347 \nonfillstart
7348 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
7349 \gobble
7351 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
7354 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
7355 % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
7356 % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
7357 % should be enough.
7358 \envdef\raggedright{%
7359 \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
7360 \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}%
7361 \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}%
7363 \let\Eraggedright\par
7365 \envdef\raggedleft{%
7366 \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
7367 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
7368 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
7369 % badness reporting.
7371 \let\Eraggedleft\par
7373 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
7374 \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
7375 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
7376 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
7377 % badness reporting.
7379 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
7382 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
7383 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
7384 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
7385 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
7387 \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
7389 \def\quotationstart{%
7390 \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
7391 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7392 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
7394 \parsearg\quotationlabel
7397 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
7398 % doing normal filling.
7400 \def\Equotation{%
7401 \par
7402 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
7403 % indent a bit.
7404 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
7406 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
7408 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
7410 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
7411 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
7412 \def\temp{#1}%
7413 \ifx\temp\empty \else
7414 {\bf #1: }%
7418 % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
7419 % has no optional argument.
7421 \makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
7423 \def\indentedblockstart{%
7424 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
7425 \parindent=0pt
7427 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
7428 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
7429 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
7430 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
7431 \else
7432 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
7436 % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
7438 \def\Eindentedblock{%
7439 \par
7440 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
7442 \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
7445 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
7446 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
7447 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
7448 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
7450 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
7452 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
7453 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
7454 % verbatim line.
7455 \def\dospecials{%
7456 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
7457 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
7458 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
7459 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
7460 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
7461 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
7462 %\do\`\do\'%
7465 % [Knuth] p. 380
7466 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
7467 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
7469 % Setup for the @verb command.
7471 % Eight spaces for a tab
7472 \begingroup
7473 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7474 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
7475 \endgroup
7477 \def\setupverb{%
7478 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7479 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
7480 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
7481 \tabeightspaces
7482 % Respect line breaks,
7483 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7484 % make each space count
7485 % must do in this order:
7486 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7489 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
7491 % Real tab expansion.
7492 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
7494 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
7495 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
7496 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
7497 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
7498 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
7499 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
7500 \newbox\verbbox
7501 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
7503 \begingroup
7504 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7505 \gdef\tabexpand{%
7506 \catcode`\^^I=\active
7507 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
7508 \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
7509 \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
7510 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
7511 \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
7512 \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
7515 \endgroup
7517 % start the verbatim environment.
7518 \def\setupverbatim{%
7519 \let\nonarrowing = t%
7520 \nonfillstart
7521 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
7522 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
7523 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
7524 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
7525 \tabexpand
7526 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
7527 % Respect line breaks,
7528 % print special symbols as themselves, and
7529 % make each space count.
7530 % Must do in this order:
7531 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
7532 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
7535 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
7536 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
7537 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
7539 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
7541 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
7542 \begingroup
7543 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
7544 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
7545 \endgroup
7547 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
7550 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
7551 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
7553 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
7555 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
7556 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
7557 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
7559 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
7561 \begingroup
7562 \catcode`\ =\active
7563 \obeylines %
7564 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
7565 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
7566 % line in the output.
7567 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
7568 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
7569 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
7570 \endgroup
7572 \envdef\verbatim{%
7573 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
7575 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
7578 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
7580 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
7582 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
7584 \makevalueexpandable
7585 \setupverbatim
7586 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
7587 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
7588 \input #1
7589 \afterenvbreak
7593 % @copying ... @end copying.
7594 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
7596 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
7597 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
7598 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
7599 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
7600 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
7601 % possible is desirable.
7603 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
7604 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
7606 \def\insertcopying{%
7607 \begingroup
7608 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
7609 \scanexp\copyingtext
7610 \endgroup
7614 \message{defuns,}
7615 % @defun etc.
7617 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
7618 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
7619 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
7620 \newcount\defunpenalty
7622 % Start the processing of @deffn:
7623 \def\startdefun{%
7624 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
7625 \medbreak
7626 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
7627 % following @def command, see below.
7628 \else
7629 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
7630 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
7631 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
7632 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
7633 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
7634 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
7635 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
7637 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
7638 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
7639 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
7640 % @def command.
7641 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
7643 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
7644 % But do insert the glue.
7645 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
7648 \parindent=0in
7649 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
7650 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7653 \def\dodefunx#1{%
7654 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
7655 \checkenv#1%
7657 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
7658 % It's not a great place, though.
7659 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
7661 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
7662 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
7664 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
7666 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
7668 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
7669 \begingroup
7670 % call \deffnheader:
7671 #1#2 \endheader
7672 % common ending:
7673 \interlinepenalty = 10000
7674 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
7675 \endgraf
7676 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
7677 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
7678 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
7679 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
7680 \checkparencounts
7681 \endgroup
7684 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
7686 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
7687 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
7689 \def\makedefun#1{%
7690 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
7691 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
7692 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
7693 \temp
7696 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader { (defn. of \deffnheader) }
7698 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
7699 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
7701 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
7702 \envdef#1{%
7703 \startdefun
7704 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
7705 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
7707 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
7708 \def#3%
7711 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
7712 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
7714 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
7715 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
7716 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
7718 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
7719 \def\temp{#1}%
7720 \ifx\temp\onword
7721 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7722 = \empty
7723 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7724 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
7725 = \relax
7726 \else
7727 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7728 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
7729 must be on|off}%
7730 \fi\fi
7733 % Untyped functions:
7735 % @deffn category name args
7736 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
7738 % @deffn category class name args
7739 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7741 % \defopon {category on}class name args
7742 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7744 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
7746 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
7747 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
7748 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
7749 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
7752 % Typed functions:
7754 % @deftypefn category type name args
7755 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
7757 % @deftypeop category class type name args
7758 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
7760 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
7761 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7763 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
7765 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7766 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7767 \doingtypefntrue
7768 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7771 % Typed variables:
7773 % @deftypevr category type var args
7774 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
7776 % @deftypecv category class type var args
7777 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7779 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
7780 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7782 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
7784 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7785 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7786 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7789 % Untyped variables:
7791 % @defvr category var args
7792 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
7794 % @defcv category class var args
7795 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7797 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
7798 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
7800 % Types:
7802 % @deftp category name args
7803 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
7804 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
7805 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
7808 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
7809 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7810 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
7811 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
7812 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7813 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7814 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
7815 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7816 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
7817 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
7818 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7819 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7821 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
7822 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
7823 % #2 is the return type, if any.
7824 % #3 is the function name.
7826 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
7828 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
7829 \par
7830 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
7831 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
7833 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
7834 % on a line by itself.
7835 \rettypeownlinefalse
7836 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
7837 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
7838 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
7839 \rettypeownlinetrue
7843 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
7844 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
7845 % just below it.
7846 \def\temp{#1}%
7847 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
7849 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
7850 % least two.
7851 \tempnum = 2
7853 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
7854 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
7855 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
7857 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
7858 \ifrettypeownline
7859 \advance\tempnum by 1
7860 \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
7861 \else
7862 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
7865 % The continuations:
7866 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
7868 % The final paragraph shape:
7869 \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
7871 % Put the category name at the right margin.
7872 \noindent
7873 \hbox to 0pt{%
7874 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
7875 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
7876 \kern\leftskip
7877 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
7880 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
7881 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
7882 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7884 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
7885 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
7886 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
7887 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
7888 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
7889 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
7890 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
7891 % one has made identifiers using them :).
7892 \df \tt
7893 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
7894 \ifx\temp\empty\else
7895 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
7896 \ifrettypeownline
7897 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
7898 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
7899 \else
7900 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
7902 \fi % no return type
7903 #3% output function name
7905 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \rmfont
7907 \boldbrax
7908 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7911 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7912 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7913 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7914 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7916 \def\defunargs#1{%
7917 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7918 % tt for the names.
7919 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
7921 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7922 % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
7923 % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
7924 % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
7925 % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
7926 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
7928 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
7931 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7933 \def\activeparens{%
7934 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
7935 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
7936 \catcode`\&=\active
7939 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7940 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
7942 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7943 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7944 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7946 \activeparens
7947 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
7948 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
7949 \global\let& = \&
7951 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
7952 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
7955 \newcount\parencount
7957 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7958 \newif\ifampseen
7959 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
7961 \def\parenfont{%
7962 \ifampseen
7963 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7964 % otherwise use the default font.
7965 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
7966 \else
7967 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7968 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7972 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7973 \ifampseen
7974 \ifnum\parencount=1
7979 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7981 \def\opnr{%
7982 \global\advance\parencount by 1
7983 {\parenfont(}%
7984 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7986 \def\clnr{%
7987 {\parenfont)}%
7988 \infirstlevel \sl
7989 \global\advance\parencount by -1
7992 \newcount\brackcount
7993 \def\lbrb{%
7994 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
7995 {\bf[}%
7997 \def\rbrb{%
7998 {\bf]}%
7999 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
8002 \def\checkparencounts{%
8003 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
8004 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
8006 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
8007 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
8008 \def\badparencount{%
8009 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
8010 \global\parencount=0
8012 \def\badbrackcount{%
8013 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
8014 \global\brackcount=0
8018 \message{macros,}
8019 % @macro.
8021 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
8022 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
8023 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
8024 \newwrite\macscribble
8025 \def\scantokens#1{%
8026 \toks0={#1}%
8027 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
8028 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
8029 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
8030 \input \jobname.tmp
8034 \let\aftermacroxxx\relax
8035 \def\aftermacro{\aftermacroxxx}
8037 % alias because \c means cedilla in @tex or @math
8038 \let\texinfoc=\c
8040 \newcount\savedcatcodeone
8041 \newcount\savedcatcodetwo
8043 % Used at the time of macro expansion.
8044 % Argument is macro body with arguments substituted
8045 \def\scanmacro#1{%
8046 \newlinechar`\^^M
8047 \def\xeatspaces{\eatspaces}%
8049 % Temporarily undo catcode changes of \printindex. Set catcode of @ to
8050 % 0 so that @-commands in macro expansions aren't printed literally when
8051 % formatting an index file, where \ is used as the escape character.
8052 \savedcatcodeone=\catcode`\@
8053 \savedcatcodetwo=\catcode`\\
8054 \catcode`\@=0
8055 \catcode`\\=\active
8057 % Process the macro body under the current catcode regime.
8058 \scantokens{#1@texinfoc}\aftermacro%
8060 \catcode`\@=\savedcatcodeone
8061 \catcode`\\=\savedcatcodetwo
8063 % The \texinfoc is to remove the \newlinechar added by \scantokens, and
8064 % can be noticed by \parsearg.
8065 % The \aftermacro allows a \comment at the end of the macro definition
8066 % to duplicate itself past the final \newlinechar added by \scantokens:
8067 % this is used in the definition of \group to comment out a newline. We
8068 % don't do the same for \c to support Texinfo files with macros that ended
8069 % with a @c, which should no longer be necessary.
8070 % We avoid surrounding the call to \scantokens with \bgroup and \egroup
8071 % to allow macros to open or close groups themselves.
8074 % Used for copying and captions
8075 \def\scanexp#1{%
8076 \expandafter\scanmacro\expandafter{#1}%
8079 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
8080 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
8081 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
8083 % List of all defined macros in the form
8084 % \commondummyword\macro1\commondummyword\macro2...
8085 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
8086 % if there is a need.
8087 \def\macrolist{}
8089 % Add the macro to \macrolist
8090 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
8091 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
8092 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\commondummyword#1}%
8093 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
8096 % Utility routines.
8097 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
8098 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
8099 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
8101 \def\cslet#1#2{%
8102 \expandafter\let
8103 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
8104 \csname#2\endcsname
8107 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
8108 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
8109 {\catcode`\@=11
8110 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
8111 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
8112 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
8113 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
8114 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
8117 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
8118 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
8119 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
8120 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
8121 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
8124 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
8125 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
8126 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
8127 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
8129 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
8130 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
8131 % confine the change to the current group.
8133 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
8134 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
8135 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
8137 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
8138 \catcode`\"=\other
8139 \catcode`\+=\other
8140 \catcode`\<=\other
8141 \catcode`\>=\other
8142 \catcode`\^=\other
8143 \catcode`\_=\other
8144 \catcode`\|=\other
8145 \catcode`\~=\other
8146 \passthroughcharstrue
8149 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
8150 \scanctxt
8151 \catcode`\@=\other
8152 \catcode`\\=\other
8153 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8156 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
8157 \scanctxt
8158 \catcode`\ =\other
8159 \catcode`\@=\other
8160 \catcode`\{=\other
8161 \catcode`\}=\other
8162 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8163 \usembodybackslash
8166 % Used when scanning braced macro arguments. Note, however, that catcode
8167 % changes here are ineffectual if the macro invocation was nested inside
8168 % an argument to another Texinfo command.
8169 \def\macroargctxt{%
8170 \scanctxt
8171 \catcode`\ =\active
8172 \catcode`\^^M=\other
8173 \catcode`\\=\active
8176 \def\macrolineargctxt{% used for whole-line arguments without braces
8177 \scanctxt
8178 \catcode`\{=\other
8179 \catcode`\}=\other
8182 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
8183 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
8184 % where N is the macro parameter number.
8185 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
8186 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
8188 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
8189 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
8190 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
8192 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
8194 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
8196 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
8197 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
8199 \def\macroxxx#1{%
8200 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
8201 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
8202 \paramno=0\relax
8203 \else
8204 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
8205 \if\paramno>256\relax
8206 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
8207 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8208 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
8212 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
8213 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
8214 \else
8215 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
8216 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
8217 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
8218 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
8219 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
8221 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
8222 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
8223 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
8224 \fi}
8226 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
8227 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
8228 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
8229 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
8230 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
8231 \begingroup
8232 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
8233 \let\commondummyword\unmacrodo
8234 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
8235 \endgroup
8236 \else
8237 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
8241 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
8242 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
8244 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
8245 \ifx #1\relax
8246 % remove this
8247 \else
8248 \noexpand\commondummyword \noexpand#1%
8252 % \getargs -- Parse the arguments to a @macro line. Set \macname to
8253 % the name of the macro, and \argl to the braced argument list.
8254 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
8255 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
8256 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
8257 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
8258 % This made use of the feature that if the last token of a
8259 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
8260 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
8262 % Parse the optional {params} list to @macro or @rmacro.
8263 % Set \paramno to the number of arguments,
8264 % and \paramlist to a parameter text for the macro (e.g. #1,#2,#3 for a
8265 % three-param macro.) Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH in the params
8266 % list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If there are
8267 % less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
8268 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
8269 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
8271 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
8273 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used: see
8274 % \parsemmanyargdef.
8276 \def\parsemargdef#1;{%
8277 \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
8278 \let\hash\relax
8279 % \hash is redefined to `#' later to get it into definitions
8280 \let\xeatspaces\relax
8281 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
8282 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
8283 \paramno0\relax
8284 \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
8287 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
8288 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
8289 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
8290 \advance\paramno by 1
8291 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
8292 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
8293 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
8294 \fi\next}
8296 % \parsemacbody, \parsermacbody
8298 % Read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. (They're different since
8299 % rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
8301 % We are in \macrobodyctxt, and the \xdef causes backslashshes in the macro
8302 % body to be transformed.
8303 % Set \macrobody to the body of the macro, and call \defmacro.
8305 {\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsemacbody#1@end macro{%
8306 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
8307 {\catcode`\ =\other\long\gdef\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro{%
8308 \xdef\macrobody{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}}%
8310 % Make @ a letter, so that we can make private-to-Texinfo macro names.
8311 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
8312 \catcode `@=11\relax
8314 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% Code for > 10 arguments only %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8316 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
8317 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
8318 % processed again to replace the arguments.
8320 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
8321 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
8322 % the catcode regime under which the body was input).
8324 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
8325 % arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error).
8327 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
8328 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
8329 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
8330 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
8331 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
8332 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
8333 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
8334 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
8335 \else
8336 \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
8337 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
8338 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
8339 \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
8340 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
8341 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
8342 % \xdef .
8343 \expandafter\edef\tempa
8344 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
8345 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
8346 \fi\next}
8349 \let\endargs@\relax
8350 \let\nil@\relax
8351 \def\nilm@{\nil@}%
8352 \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
8354 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
8355 % definition. It gets all the arguments' values and assigns them to macros
8356 % macarg.ARGNAME
8358 % #1 is the macro name
8359 % #2 is the list of argument names
8360 % #3 is the list of argument values
8361 \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
8362 \def\macargdeflist@{}%
8363 \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
8364 \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
8365 \def\macroname{#1}%
8366 \begingroup
8367 \macroargctxt
8368 \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
8369 \def\@tempa{#3}%
8370 \ifx\@tempa\empty
8371 \setemptyargvalues@
8372 \else
8373 \getargvals@@
8376 \def\getargvals@@{%
8377 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8378 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
8379 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
8380 \else
8381 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8382 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
8384 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8385 \else
8386 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
8387 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
8388 % macros to empty.
8389 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8390 \else
8391 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
8392 \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
8393 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
8394 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
8395 \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
8396 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
8397 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
8398 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
8399 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
8400 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
8401 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
8402 \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
8403 \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
8404 \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
8405 \let\next\getargvals@@
8408 \next
8411 \def\push@#1#2{%
8412 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
8413 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
8414 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
8415 \expandafter#1#2}%
8418 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
8419 % in macro \@tempa.
8421 \def\macvalstoargs@{%
8422 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
8423 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
8424 % values into respective token registers.
8426 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
8427 \begingroup
8428 \paramno0\relax
8429 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
8430 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
8431 \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
8432 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
8433 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
8434 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
8435 \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
8436 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
8437 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
8438 % group.
8439 \expandafter
8440 \endgroup
8441 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
8444 % Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
8446 \def\macargexpandinbody@{%
8447 \expandafter
8448 \endgroup
8449 \macargdeflist@
8450 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
8451 % is in \@tempa .
8452 \macvalstoargs@
8453 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
8454 % with \@tempb .
8455 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
8456 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
8457 % \egroup .
8458 \ifx\@tempb\gobble
8459 \let\@tempc\relax
8460 \else
8461 \let\@tempc\egroup
8463 % And now we do the real job:
8464 \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
8465 \@tempd
8468 \def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
8469 \if#1;\let\next\relax
8470 \else
8471 \let\next\putargsintokens@
8472 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
8473 % alias \@tempb .
8474 \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
8475 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
8476 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
8477 \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
8478 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
8480 \next
8483 % Trailing missing arguments are set to empty.
8485 \def\setemptyargvalues@{%
8486 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
8487 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
8488 \else
8489 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
8490 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
8492 \next
8495 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
8496 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
8497 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
8498 \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
8499 \def\paramlist{#2}%
8502 % #1 is the element target macro
8503 % #2 is the list macro
8504 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
8505 \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
8506 \def#1{#3}%
8507 \def#2{#4}%
8509 \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
8510 \long\def#1{#3}%
8511 \long\def#2{#4}%
8515 %%%%%%%%%%%%%% End of code for > 10 arguments %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8518 % This defines a Texinfo @macro or @rmacro, called by \parsemacbody.
8519 % \macrobody has the body of the macro in it, with placeholders for
8520 % its parameters, looking like "\xeatspaces{\hash 1}".
8521 % \paramno is the number of parameters
8522 % \paramlist is a TeX parameter text, e.g. "#1,#2,#3,"
8523 % There are four cases: macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
8524 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
8525 % they're defined in: @include reads the file inside a group.
8527 \def\defmacro{%
8528 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
8529 \ifnum\paramno=1
8530 \def\xeatspaces##1{##1}%
8531 % This removes the pair of braces around the argument. We don't
8532 % use \eatspaces, because this can cause ends of lines to be lost
8533 % when the argument to \eatspaces is read, leading to line-based
8534 % commands like "@itemize" not being read correctly.
8535 \else
8536 \let\xeatspaces\relax % suppress expansion
8538 \ifcase\paramno
8540 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8541 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8542 \or % 1
8543 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8544 \bgroup
8545 \noexpand\braceorline
8546 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname}%
8547 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
8548 \egroup
8549 \noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}%
8551 \else % at most 9
8552 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
8553 % @MACNAME sets the context for reading the macro argument
8554 % @MACNAME@@ gets the argument, processes backslashes and appends a
8555 % comma.
8556 % @MACNAME@@@ removes braces surrounding the argument list.
8557 % @MACNAME@@@@ scans the macro body with arguments substituted.
8558 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8559 \bgroup
8560 \noexpand\expandafter % This \expandafter skip any spaces after the
8561 \noexpand\macroargctxt % macro before we change the catcode of space.
8562 \noexpand\expandafter
8563 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname}%
8564 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@\endcsname##1{%
8565 \noexpand\passargtomacro
8566 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname{##1,}}%
8567 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname @@@\endcsname##1{%
8568 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname ##1}%
8569 \expandafter\expandafter
8570 \expandafter\xdef
8571 \expandafter\expandafter
8572 \csname\the\macname @@@@\endcsname\paramlist{%
8573 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\macrobody}}%
8574 \else % 10 or more:
8575 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
8576 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
8578 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\macrobody
8579 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
8581 \fi}
8583 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax % end private-to-Texinfo catcodes
8585 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
8588 %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8590 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=13 % We need to manipulate \ so use @ as escape
8591 @catcode`@_=11 % private names
8592 @catcode`@!=11 % used as argument separator
8594 % \passargtomacro#1#2 -
8595 % Call #1 with a list of tokens #2, with any doubled backslashes in #2
8596 % compressed to one.
8598 % This implementation works by expansion, and not execution (so we cannot use
8599 % \def or similar). This reduces the risk of this failing in contexts where
8600 % complete expansion is done with no execution (for example, in writing out to
8601 % an auxiliary file for an index entry).
8603 % State is kept in the input stream: the argument passed to
8604 % @look_ahead, @gobble_and_check_finish and @add_segment is
8606 % THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT ! {PENDING_BS} NEXT_TOKEN (... rest of input)
8608 % where:
8609 % THE_MACRO - name of the macro we want to call
8610 % ARG_RESULT - argument list we build to pass to that macro
8611 % PENDING_BS - either a backslash or nothing
8612 % NEXT_TOKEN - used to look ahead in the input stream to see what's coming next
8614 @gdef@passargtomacro#1#2{%
8615 @add_segment #1!{}@relax#2\@_finish\%
8617 @gdef@_finish{@_finishx} @global@let@_finishx@relax
8619 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8620 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8621 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8622 % #4 used to look ahead
8624 % If the next token is not a backslash, process the rest of the argument;
8625 % otherwise, remove the next token.
8626 @gdef@look_ahead#1!#2#3#4{%
8627 @ifx#4\%
8628 @expandafter@gobble_and_check_finish
8629 @else
8630 @expandafter@add_segment
8631 @fi#1!{#2}#4#4%
8634 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8635 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8636 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8637 % #4 should be a backslash, which is gobbled.
8638 % #5 looks ahead
8640 % Double backslash found. Add a single backslash, and look ahead.
8641 @gdef@gobble_and_check_finish#1!#2#3#4#5{%
8642 @add_segment#1\!{}#5#5%
8645 @gdef@is_fi{@fi}
8647 % #1 - THE_MACRO ARG_RESULT
8648 % #2 - PENDING_BS
8649 % #3 - NEXT_TOKEN
8650 % #4 is input stream until next backslash
8652 % Input stream is either at the start of the argument, or just after a
8653 % backslash sequence, either a lone backslash, or a doubled backslash.
8654 % NEXT_TOKEN contains the first token in the input stream: if it is \finish,
8655 % finish; otherwise, append to ARG_RESULT the segment of the argument up until
8656 % the next backslash. PENDING_BACKSLASH contains a backslash to represent
8657 % a backslash just before the start of the input stream that has not been
8658 % added to ARG_RESULT.
8659 @gdef@add_segment#1!#2#3#4\{%
8660 @ifx#3@_finish
8661 @call_the_macro#1!%
8662 @else
8663 % append the pending backslash to the result, followed by the next segment
8664 @expandafter@is_fi@look_ahead#1#2#4!{\}@fi
8665 % this @fi is discarded by @look_ahead.
8666 % we can't get rid of it with \expandafter because we don't know how
8667 % long #4 is.
8670 % #1 - THE_MACRO
8671 % #2 - ARG_RESULT
8672 % #3 discards the res of the conditional in @add_segment, and @is_fi ends the
8673 % conditional.
8674 @gdef@call_the_macro#1#2!#3@fi{@is_fi #1{#2}}
8677 %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
8679 % \braceorline MAC is used for a one-argument macro MAC. It checks
8680 % whether the next non-whitespace character is a {. It sets the context
8681 % for reading the argument (slightly different in the two cases). Then,
8682 % to read the argument, in the whole-line case, it then calls the regular
8683 % \parsearg MAC; in the lbrace case, it calls \passargtomacro MAC.
8685 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
8686 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
8687 \ifx\nchar\bgroup
8688 \macroargctxt
8689 \expandafter\passargtomacro
8690 \else
8691 \macrolineargctxt\expandafter\parsearg
8692 \fi \macnamexxx}
8695 % @alias.
8696 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
8697 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
8699 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
8700 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
8701 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
8703 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
8704 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
8705 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
8707 \next
8711 \message{cross references,}
8713 \newwrite\auxfile
8714 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
8715 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
8717 % @inforef is relatively simple.
8718 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
8719 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
8720 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
8721 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
8723 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
8724 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
8725 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
8726 % @node foo , bar , ...
8727 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
8729 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
8731 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
8732 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
8733 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
8734 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
8736 \let\nwnode=\node
8737 \let\lastnode=\empty
8739 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
8740 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
8742 \def\donoderef#1{%
8743 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
8744 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
8745 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
8749 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
8751 \newcount\savesfregister
8753 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
8754 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
8755 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
8757 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
8758 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
8759 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
8760 % or the anchor name.
8761 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
8762 % empty for anchors.
8763 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
8765 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
8766 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
8767 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
8769 \def\setref#1#2{%
8770 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
8771 \iflinks
8773 \requireauxfile
8774 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
8775 % match definition in \xrdef, \refx, \xrefX.
8776 \def\value##1{##1}%
8777 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
8778 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
8779 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
8781 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
8782 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
8783 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
8784 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
8789 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
8790 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
8791 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
8792 % variable, now it's official.
8794 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
8795 \def\temp{#1}%
8796 \ifx\temp\onword
8797 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
8798 = \empty
8799 \else\ifx\temp\offword
8800 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
8801 = \relax
8802 \else
8803 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8804 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
8805 must be on|off}%
8806 \fi\fi
8809 % \f
8810 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
8811 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
8812 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
8813 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
8815 \def\pxref{\putwordsee{} \xrefXX}
8816 \def\xref{\putwordSee{} \xrefXX}
8817 \def\ref{\xrefXX}
8819 \def\xrefXX#1{\def\xrefXXarg{#1}\futurelet\tokenafterxref\xrefXXX}
8820 \def\xrefXXX{\expandafter\xrefX\expandafter[\xrefXXarg,,,,,,,]}
8822 \newbox\toprefbox
8823 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
8824 \newbox\infofilenamebox
8825 \newbox\printedmanualbox
8827 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
8828 \unsepspaces
8830 % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
8831 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
8832 \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
8834 \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
8835 \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
8837 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
8838 \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
8840 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
8841 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
8842 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8843 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
8844 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
8845 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
8846 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8847 \else
8848 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
8849 % the square brackets if we have it.
8850 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8851 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
8852 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8853 \else
8854 \ifhavexrefs
8855 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
8856 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
8857 \else
8858 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
8859 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
8860 \fi%
8865 % Make link in pdf output.
8866 \ifpdf
8867 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX
8868 {\indexnofonts
8869 \makevalueexpandable
8870 \turnoffactive
8871 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8872 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8873 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8874 \getfilename{#4}%
8876 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8877 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8878 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
8880 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
8881 \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
8884 \leavevmode
8885 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
8886 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8887 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfdestname}%
8888 \else
8889 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfdestname}}%
8892 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8893 \else
8894 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
8895 \else
8896 % For XeTeX
8897 {\indexnofonts
8898 \makevalueexpandable
8899 \turnoffactive
8900 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8901 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8902 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8903 \getfilename{#4}%
8905 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8906 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8907 \setpdfdestname{#1}%
8909 \ifx\pdfdestname\empty
8910 \def\pdfdestname{Top}% no empty targets
8913 \leavevmode
8914 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8915 % With default settings,
8916 % XeTeX (xdvipdfmx) replaces link destination names with integers.
8917 % In this case, the replaced destination names of
8918 % remote PDFs are no longer known. In order to avoid a replacement,
8919 % you can use xdvipdfmx's command line option `-C 0x0010'.
8920 % If you use XeTeX 0.99996+ (TeX Live 2016+),
8921 % this command line option is no longer necessary
8922 % because we can use the `dvipdfmx:config' special.
8923 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
8924 << /S /GoToR /F (\the\filename.pdf) /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
8925 \else
8926 \special{pdf:bann << /Border [0 0 0] /Type /Annot /Subtype /Link /A
8927 << /S /GoTo /D (\pdfdestname) >> >>}%
8930 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8934 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
8935 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
8936 \indexnofonts
8937 \turnoffactive
8938 \def\value##1{##1}%
8939 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
8940 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
8943 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
8944 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". \iffloat distinguishes them by
8945 % \Xthisreftitle being set to a magic string.
8946 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
8947 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
8948 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
8949 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8950 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
8951 \else
8952 \printedrefname
8955 % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
8956 % "in MANUALNAME".
8957 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8958 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
8960 \else
8961 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
8963 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
8964 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
8965 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
8966 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
8967 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
8968 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
8970 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8971 % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
8973 \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
8975 \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
8976 % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
8977 % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
8978 % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
8980 \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
8982 \else
8983 % Reference within this manual.
8985 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
8986 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
8987 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
8988 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
8989 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
8990 {\turnoffactive
8991 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
8992 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
8993 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
8994 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
8996 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
8997 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
8999 % But we always want a comma and a space:
9000 ,\space
9002 % output the `page 3'.
9003 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
9004 % Add a , if xref followed by a space
9005 \if\space\noexpand\tokenafterxref ,%
9006 \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @TAB
9007 \else\ifx\*\tokenafterxref ,% @*
9008 \else\ifx\ \tokenafterxref ,% @SPACE
9009 \else\ifx\
9010 \tokenafterxref ,% @NL
9011 \else\ifx\tie\tokenafterxref ,% @tie
9012 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
9013 \fi\fi
9015 \endlink
9016 \endgroup}
9018 % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
9020 % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
9021 % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
9022 % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
9024 % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
9025 % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
9026 % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
9027 % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
9028 % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
9030 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
9031 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
9033 \def\crossmanualxref#1{%
9034 \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
9035 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
9036 \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
9037 \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
9038 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
9044 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
9045 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
9046 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
9047 % one that Bob is working on :).
9049 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
9051 % Things referred to by \setref.
9053 \def\Ynothing{}
9054 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
9055 \def\Ynumbered{%
9056 \ifnum\secno=0
9057 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
9058 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
9059 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
9060 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
9061 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
9062 \else
9063 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
9064 \fi\fi\fi
9066 \def\Yappendix{%
9067 \ifnum\secno=0
9068 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
9069 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
9070 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
9071 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
9072 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
9073 \else
9074 \putwordSection@tie
9075 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
9076 \fi\fi\fi
9079 % \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} - reference a cross-reference string named NAME. SUFFIX
9080 % is output afterwards if non-empty.
9081 \def\refx#1#2{%
9082 \requireauxfile
9084 \indexnofonts
9085 \otherbackslash
9086 \def\value##1{##1}%
9087 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
9088 \csname XR#1\endcsname
9090 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
9091 % If not defined, say something at least.
9092 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
9093 \iflinks
9094 \ifhavexrefs
9095 {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
9096 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
9097 \else
9098 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
9099 \global\warnedxrefstrue
9100 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
9104 \else
9105 % It's defined, so just use it.
9106 \thisrefX
9108 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
9111 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Define a control
9112 % sequence for a cross-reference target (we prepend XR to the control sequence
9113 % name to avoid collisions). The value is the page number. If this is a float
9114 % type, we have more work to do.
9116 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
9117 {% Expand the node or anchor name to remove control sequences.
9118 % \turnoffactive stops 8-bit characters being changed to commands
9119 % like @'e. \refx does the same to retrieve the value in the definition.
9120 \indexnofonts
9121 \turnoffactive
9122 \def\value##1{##1}%
9123 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
9126 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
9128 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
9129 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
9130 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
9131 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
9132 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
9134 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
9135 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
9136 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
9137 \else
9138 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
9139 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
9142 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
9143 % for later use in \listoffloats.
9144 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
9145 {\safexrefname}}%
9149 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
9150 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
9151 % This is done with @novalidate at the beginning of the file.
9153 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
9154 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
9156 % Used when writing to the aux file, or when using data from it.
9157 \def\requireauxfile{%
9158 \iflinks
9159 \tryauxfile
9160 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
9161 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
9163 \global\let\requireauxfile=\relax % Only do this once.
9166 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
9168 \def\tryauxfile{%
9169 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
9170 \ifeof 1 \else
9171 \readdatafile{aux}%
9172 \global\havexrefstrue
9174 \closein 1
9177 \def\setupdatafile{%
9178 \catcode`\^^@=\other
9179 \catcode`\^^A=\other
9180 \catcode`\^^B=\other
9181 \catcode`\^^C=\other
9182 \catcode`\^^D=\other
9183 \catcode`\^^E=\other
9184 \catcode`\^^F=\other
9185 \catcode`\^^G=\other
9186 \catcode`\^^H=\other
9187 \catcode`\^^K=\other
9188 \catcode`\^^L=\other
9189 \catcode`\^^N=\other
9190 \catcode`\^^P=\other
9191 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
9192 \catcode`\^^R=\other
9193 \catcode`\^^S=\other
9194 \catcode`\^^T=\other
9195 \catcode`\^^U=\other
9196 \catcode`\^^V=\other
9197 \catcode`\^^W=\other
9198 \catcode`\^^X=\other
9199 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
9200 \catcode`\^^[=\other
9201 \catcode`\^^\=\other
9202 \catcode`\^^]=\other
9203 \catcode`\^^^=\other
9204 \catcode`\^^_=\other
9205 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
9206 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
9207 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
9208 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
9209 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
9210 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
9211 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
9212 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
9214 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
9215 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
9216 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
9218 \catcode`\^=\other
9220 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
9221 \catcode`\~=\other
9222 \catcode`\[=\other
9223 \catcode`\]=\other
9224 \catcode`\"=\other
9225 \catcode`\_=\other
9226 \catcode`\|=\other
9227 \catcode`\<=\other
9228 \catcode`\>=\other
9229 \catcode`\$=\other
9230 \catcode`\#=\other
9231 \catcode`\&=\other
9232 \catcode`\%=\other
9233 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
9235 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
9236 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
9237 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
9238 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
9239 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
9240 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
9241 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
9242 \catcode`\\=\other
9244 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
9245 \catcode`\{=1
9246 \catcode`\}=2
9247 \catcode`\@=0
9250 \def\readdatafile#1{%
9251 \begingroup
9252 \setupdatafile
9253 \input\jobname.#1
9254 \endgroup}
9257 \message{insertions,}
9258 % including footnotes.
9260 \newcount \footnoteno
9262 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
9263 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
9264 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
9265 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
9266 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
9267 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
9269 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
9270 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
9272 {\catcode `\@=11
9274 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
9275 \gdef\footnote{%
9276 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
9277 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
9279 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
9280 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
9281 \let\@sf\empty
9282 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
9284 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
9285 \unskip
9286 \thisfootno\@sf
9287 \dofootnote
9290 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
9291 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
9293 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
9294 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
9295 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
9297 \gdef\dofootnote{%
9298 \insert\footins\bgroup
9300 % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
9301 % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
9302 \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest
9304 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
9305 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
9306 % So reset some parameters.
9307 \hsize=\txipagewidth
9308 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
9309 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
9310 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
9311 \floatingpenalty\@MM
9312 \leftskip\z@skip
9313 \rightskip\z@skip
9314 \spaceskip\z@skip
9315 \xspaceskip\z@skip
9316 \parindent\defaultparindent
9318 \smallfonts \rm
9320 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
9321 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
9322 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
9323 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
9324 \let\noindent = \relax
9326 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
9327 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
9328 \everypar = {\hang}%
9329 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
9331 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
9332 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
9333 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
9334 \footstrut
9336 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
9337 \futurelet\next\fo@t
9339 }%end \catcode `\@=11
9341 \def\errfootnotenest{%
9342 \errhelp=\EMsimple
9343 \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
9344 even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
9347 \def\errfootnoteheading{%
9348 \errhelp=\EMsimple
9349 \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported}
9352 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
9353 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
9354 % would be lost.
9355 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
9356 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
9357 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
9359 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
9360 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
9361 % out prematurely.
9363 \def\startsavinginserts{%
9364 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
9365 \let\insert\saveinsert
9366 \else
9367 \let\checkinserts\relax
9371 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
9372 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
9374 \def\saveinsert#1{%
9375 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
9376 \afterassignment\next
9377 % swallow the left brace
9378 \let\temp =
9380 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
9381 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
9383 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
9385 \def\placesaveins#1{%
9386 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
9387 {\box#1}%
9390 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
9392 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
9393 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
9396 % initialization:
9397 \def\newsaveins #1{%
9398 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
9399 \next
9401 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
9402 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
9403 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
9404 \checksaveins #1}%
9407 % initialize:
9408 \let\checkinserts\empty
9409 \newsaveins\footins
9410 \newsaveins\margin
9413 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
9414 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
9416 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
9417 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
9418 % undone and the next image would fail.
9419 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
9420 \ifeof 1 \else
9421 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
9422 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
9423 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
9424 \input epsf.tex
9426 \closein 1
9428 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
9429 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
9430 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
9431 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
9432 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
9434 \def\image#1{%
9435 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
9436 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
9437 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
9438 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
9439 \global\warnednoepsftrue
9441 \else
9442 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
9446 % Arguments to @image:
9447 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
9448 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
9449 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
9450 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
9451 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
9452 \newif\ifimagevmode
9453 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
9454 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
9455 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
9456 \def\xprocessmacroarg{\eatspaces}% in case we are being used via a macro
9457 % If the image is by itself, center it.
9458 \ifvmode
9459 \imagevmodetrue
9460 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
9461 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
9462 \imagevmodetrue
9463 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
9464 \fi\fi
9466 \ifimagevmode
9467 \nobreak\medskip
9468 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
9469 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
9470 % above and below.
9471 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
9472 \nobreak
9475 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
9476 % environment such as @quotation is respected.
9477 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
9478 % normal paragraph indentation.
9479 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
9480 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
9481 % eradicate the centering.
9482 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
9484 % Output the image.
9485 \ifpdf
9486 % For pdfTeX and LuaTeX <= 0.80
9487 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9488 \else
9489 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9490 % For epsf.tex
9491 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
9492 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
9493 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
9494 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
9495 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
9496 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
9497 \else
9498 % For XeTeX
9499 \doxeteximage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
9503 \ifimagevmode
9504 \medskip % space after a standalone image
9506 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
9507 \endgroup}
9510 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
9511 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
9512 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
9514 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
9516 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
9517 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
9519 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
9520 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
9521 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
9523 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
9524 % be referable.
9526 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
9527 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
9529 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
9530 % chapter-level command.
9531 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
9533 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
9534 \let\thiscaption=\empty
9535 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
9537 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
9539 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
9540 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
9542 \startsavinginserts
9544 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
9545 \par
9547 \vtop\bgroup
9548 \def\floattype{#1}%
9549 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
9550 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
9552 \ifx\floattype\empty
9553 \let\safefloattype=\empty
9554 \else
9556 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9557 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9558 \indexnofonts
9559 \turnoffactive
9560 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9564 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
9565 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9566 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
9567 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
9569 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
9570 \global\advance\floatno by 1
9573 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
9574 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
9575 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
9576 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
9577 % lists of floats.
9579 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
9580 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
9584 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
9585 \vskip\parskip
9587 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
9588 \restorefirstparagraphindent
9591 % we have these possibilities:
9592 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
9593 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
9594 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
9595 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
9596 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
9597 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
9598 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
9599 % @float & no caption:
9601 \def\Efloat{%
9602 \let\floatident = \empty
9604 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
9605 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
9607 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
9608 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9609 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
9610 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
9612 % the number.
9613 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9616 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
9617 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
9618 \let\captionline = \floatident
9620 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
9621 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
9622 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
9625 % caption text.
9626 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
9629 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
9630 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
9631 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
9632 \vskip.5\parskip
9633 \captionline
9635 % Space below caption.
9636 \vskip\parskip
9639 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
9640 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
9641 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
9642 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
9643 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
9644 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
9646 \requireauxfile
9647 \atdummies
9649 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
9650 \def\gtemp{\thiscaption}%
9651 \else
9652 \def\gtemp{\thisshortcaption}%
9654 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
9655 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
9658 \egroup % end of \vtop
9660 \checkinserts
9663 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
9665 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
9666 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
9669 % @caption, @shortcaption
9671 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
9672 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
9673 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
9674 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
9676 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
9677 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
9678 \def\getfloatno#1{%
9679 \ifx#1\relax
9680 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
9681 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
9683 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
9684 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
9685 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
9687 \let\floatno#1%
9690 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
9691 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
9692 % first read the @float command.
9694 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
9696 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
9697 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
9698 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
9700 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
9701 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
9702 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
9704 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
9706 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
9707 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
9709 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
9710 \def\temp{#1}%
9711 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
9712 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
9715 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
9717 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
9718 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
9720 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
9721 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
9722 \indexnofonts
9723 \turnoffactive
9724 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
9727 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
9728 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
9729 \ifhavexrefs
9730 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
9731 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
9733 \else
9734 \begingroup
9735 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
9736 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
9737 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
9738 \endgroup
9742 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
9743 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
9744 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
9745 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
9747 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
9748 % they won't appear in the aux file).
9750 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
9751 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
9752 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
9753 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
9754 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
9755 % in pdf output.
9756 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
9758 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
9759 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
9760 \writeentry
9764 \message{localization,}
9766 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
9767 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
9768 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
9771 \catcode`\_ = \active
9772 \globaldefs=1
9773 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
9774 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
9775 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
9776 \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test
9777 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
9778 \ifeof 1
9779 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish
9780 \else
9781 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9782 \input txi-#1.tex
9784 \closein 1
9785 \endgroup % end raw TeX
9788 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
9789 % try txi-de.tex.
9791 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
9792 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
9793 \ifeof 1
9794 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
9795 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
9796 \else
9797 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
9798 \input txi-#1.tex
9800 \closein 1
9802 }% end of special _ catcode
9804 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
9805 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
9806 directory should work if nowhere else does.}
9808 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
9809 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
9810 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
9812 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
9813 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
9814 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
9816 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
9817 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
9818 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
9819 % accented characters problem.)
9821 \catcode`@=11
9822 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
9823 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
9824 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
9825 \message{no patterns for #1}%
9826 \else
9827 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
9829 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
9830 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
9831 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
9834 % XeTeX and LuaTeX can handle Unicode natively.
9835 % Their default I/O uses UTF-8 sequences instead of a byte-wise operation.
9836 % Other TeX engines' I/O (pdfTeX, etc.) is byte-wise.
9838 \newif\iftxinativeunicodecapable
9839 \newif\iftxiusebytewiseio
9841 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9842 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
9843 \txinativeunicodecapablefalse
9844 \txiusebytewiseiotrue
9845 \else
9846 \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
9847 \txiusebytewiseiofalse
9849 \else
9850 \txinativeunicodecapabletrue
9851 \txiusebytewiseiofalse
9854 % Set I/O by bytes instead of UTF-8 sequence for XeTeX and LuaTex
9855 % for non-UTF-8 (byte-wise) encodings.
9857 \def\setbytewiseio{%
9858 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9859 \else
9860 \XeTeXdefaultencoding "bytes" % For subsequent files to be read
9861 \XeTeXinputencoding "bytes" % For document root file
9862 % Unfortunately, there seems to be no corresponding XeTeX command for
9863 % output encoding. This is a problem for auxiliary index and TOC files.
9864 % The only solution would be perhaps to write out @U{...} sequences in
9865 % place of non-ASCII characters.
9868 \ifx\luatexversion\thisisundefined
9869 \else
9870 \directlua{
9871 local utf8_char, byte, gsub = unicode.utf8.char, string.byte, string.gsub
9872 local function convert_char (char)
9873 return utf8_char(byte(char))
9876 local function convert_line (line)
9877 return gsub(line, ".", convert_char)
9880 callback.register("process_input_buffer", convert_line)
9882 local function convert_line_out (line)
9883 local line_out = ""
9884 for c in string.utfvalues(line) do
9885 line_out = line_out .. string.char(c)
9887 return line_out
9890 callback.register("process_output_buffer", convert_line_out)
9894 \txiusebytewiseiotrue
9898 % Helpers for encodings.
9899 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
9901 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
9902 \count255=128
9903 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
9904 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
9905 \advance\count255 by 1
9906 \repeat
9909 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
9910 \count255=128
9911 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
9912 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
9913 \advance\count255 by 1
9914 \repeat
9917 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
9918 % according to the specified encoding.
9920 \def\documentencoding{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\documentencodingzzz}
9921 \def\documentencodingzzz#1{%
9923 % Encoding being declared for the document.
9924 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
9926 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
9927 % to compare them with \ifx.
9928 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
9929 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
9930 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
9931 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
9932 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
9934 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
9935 \asciichardefs
9937 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
9938 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9939 \setbytewiseio
9941 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9942 \lattwochardefs
9944 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
9945 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9946 \setbytewiseio
9948 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9949 \latonechardefs
9951 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
9952 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9953 \setbytewiseio
9955 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9956 \latninechardefs
9958 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
9959 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
9960 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX)
9961 \nativeunicodechardefs
9962 \else
9963 % For treating UTF-8 as byte sequences (TeX, eTeX and pdfTeX)
9964 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
9965 % since we already invoked \utfeightchardefs at the top level
9966 % (below), do not re-invoke it, otherwise our check for duplicated
9967 % definitions gets triggered. Making non-ascii chars active is
9968 % sufficient.
9971 \else
9972 \message{Ignoring unknown document encoding: #1.}%
9974 \fi % utfeight
9975 \fi % latnine
9976 \fi % latone
9977 \fi % lattwo
9978 \fi % ascii
9980 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
9981 \else
9982 \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
9983 \else
9984 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
9985 \else
9986 \message{Warning: XeTeX with non-UTF-8 encodings cannot handle %
9987 non-ASCII characters in auxiliary files.}%
9993 % emacs-page
9994 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
9995 % the default font encoding (OT1).
9997 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing, sorry: #1.}}
9999 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
10000 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
10002 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
10003 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
10004 % macros containing the character definitions.
10005 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
10008 \def\gdefchar#1#2{%
10009 \gdef#1{%
10010 \ifpassthroughchars
10011 \string#1%
10012 \else
10017 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
10018 \def\latonechardefs{%
10019 \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
10020 \gdefchar^^a1{\exclamdown}
10021 \gdefchar^^a2{{\tcfont \char162}} % cent
10022 \gdefchar^^a3{\pounds{}}
10023 \gdefchar^^a4{{\tcfont \char164}} % currency
10024 \gdefchar^^a5{{\tcfont \char165}} % yen
10025 \gdefchar^^a6{{\tcfont \char166}} % broken bar
10026 \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
10027 \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
10028 \gdefchar^^a9{\copyright{}}
10029 \gdefchar^^aa{\ordf}
10030 \gdefchar^^ab{\guillemetleft{}}
10031 \gdefchar^^ac{\ensuremath\lnot}
10032 \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
10033 \gdefchar^^ae{\registeredsymbol{}}
10034 \gdefchar^^af{\={}}
10036 \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree}
10037 \gdefchar^^b1{$\pm$}
10038 \gdefchar^^b2{$^2$}
10039 \gdefchar^^b3{$^3$}
10040 \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
10041 \gdefchar^^b5{$\mu$}
10042 \gdefchar^^b6{\P}
10043 \gdefchar^^b7{\ensuremath\cdot}
10044 \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
10045 \gdefchar^^b9{$^1$}
10046 \gdefchar^^ba{\ordm}
10047 \gdefchar^^bb{\guillemetright{}}
10048 \gdefchar^^bc{$1\over4$}
10049 \gdefchar^^bd{$1\over2$}
10050 \gdefchar^^be{$3\over4$}
10051 \gdefchar^^bf{\questiondown}
10053 \gdefchar^^c0{\`A}
10054 \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
10055 \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
10056 \gdefchar^^c3{\~A}
10057 \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
10058 \gdefchar^^c5{\ringaccent A}
10059 \gdefchar^^c6{\AE}
10060 \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
10061 \gdefchar^^c8{\`E}
10062 \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
10063 \gdefchar^^ca{\^E}
10064 \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
10065 \gdefchar^^cc{\`I}
10066 \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
10067 \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
10068 \gdefchar^^cf{\"I}
10070 \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
10071 \gdefchar^^d1{\~N}
10072 \gdefchar^^d2{\`O}
10073 \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
10074 \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
10075 \gdefchar^^d5{\~O}
10076 \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
10077 \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
10078 \gdefchar^^d8{\O}
10079 \gdefchar^^d9{\`U}
10080 \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
10081 \gdefchar^^db{\^U}
10082 \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
10083 \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
10084 \gdefchar^^de{\TH}
10085 \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
10087 \gdefchar^^e0{\`a}
10088 \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
10089 \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
10090 \gdefchar^^e3{\~a}
10091 \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
10092 \gdefchar^^e5{\ringaccent a}
10093 \gdefchar^^e6{\ae}
10094 \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
10095 \gdefchar^^e8{\`e}
10096 \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
10097 \gdefchar^^ea{\^e}
10098 \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
10099 \gdefchar^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
10100 \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
10101 \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
10102 \gdefchar^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
10104 \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
10105 \gdefchar^^f1{\~n}
10106 \gdefchar^^f2{\`o}
10107 \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
10108 \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
10109 \gdefchar^^f5{\~o}
10110 \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
10111 \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
10112 \gdefchar^^f8{\o}
10113 \gdefchar^^f9{\`u}
10114 \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
10115 \gdefchar^^fb{\^u}
10116 \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
10117 \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
10118 \gdefchar^^fe{\th}
10119 \gdefchar^^ff{\"y}
10122 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
10123 \def\latninechardefs{%
10124 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
10125 \latonechardefs
10127 \gdefchar^^a4{\euro{}}
10128 \gdefchar^^a6{\v S}
10129 \gdefchar^^a8{\v s}
10130 \gdefchar^^b4{\v Z}
10131 \gdefchar^^b8{\v z}
10132 \gdefchar^^bc{\OE}
10133 \gdefchar^^bd{\oe}
10134 \gdefchar^^be{\"Y}
10137 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
10138 \def\lattwochardefs{%
10139 \gdefchar^^a0{\tie}
10140 \gdefchar^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
10141 \gdefchar^^a2{\u{}}
10142 \gdefchar^^a3{\L}
10143 \gdefchar^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
10144 \gdefchar^^a5{\v L}
10145 \gdefchar^^a6{\'S}
10146 \gdefchar^^a7{\S}
10147 \gdefchar^^a8{\"{}}
10148 \gdefchar^^a9{\v S}
10149 \gdefchar^^aa{\cedilla S}
10150 \gdefchar^^ab{\v T}
10151 \gdefchar^^ac{\'Z}
10152 \gdefchar^^ad{\-}
10153 \gdefchar^^ae{\v Z}
10154 \gdefchar^^af{\dotaccent Z}
10156 \gdefchar^^b0{\textdegree{}}
10157 \gdefchar^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
10158 \gdefchar^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
10159 \gdefchar^^b3{\l}
10160 \gdefchar^^b4{\'{}}
10161 \gdefchar^^b5{\v l}
10162 \gdefchar^^b6{\'s}
10163 \gdefchar^^b7{\v{}}
10164 \gdefchar^^b8{\cedilla\ }
10165 \gdefchar^^b9{\v s}
10166 \gdefchar^^ba{\cedilla s}
10167 \gdefchar^^bb{\v t}
10168 \gdefchar^^bc{\'z}
10169 \gdefchar^^bd{\H{}}
10170 \gdefchar^^be{\v z}
10171 \gdefchar^^bf{\dotaccent z}
10173 \gdefchar^^c0{\'R}
10174 \gdefchar^^c1{\'A}
10175 \gdefchar^^c2{\^A}
10176 \gdefchar^^c3{\u A}
10177 \gdefchar^^c4{\"A}
10178 \gdefchar^^c5{\'L}
10179 \gdefchar^^c6{\'C}
10180 \gdefchar^^c7{\cedilla C}
10181 \gdefchar^^c8{\v C}
10182 \gdefchar^^c9{\'E}
10183 \gdefchar^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
10184 \gdefchar^^cb{\"E}
10185 \gdefchar^^cc{\v E}
10186 \gdefchar^^cd{\'I}
10187 \gdefchar^^ce{\^I}
10188 \gdefchar^^cf{\v D}
10190 \gdefchar^^d0{\DH}
10191 \gdefchar^^d1{\'N}
10192 \gdefchar^^d2{\v N}
10193 \gdefchar^^d3{\'O}
10194 \gdefchar^^d4{\^O}
10195 \gdefchar^^d5{\H O}
10196 \gdefchar^^d6{\"O}
10197 \gdefchar^^d7{$\times$}
10198 \gdefchar^^d8{\v R}
10199 \gdefchar^^d9{\ringaccent U}
10200 \gdefchar^^da{\'U}
10201 \gdefchar^^db{\H U}
10202 \gdefchar^^dc{\"U}
10203 \gdefchar^^dd{\'Y}
10204 \gdefchar^^de{\cedilla T}
10205 \gdefchar^^df{\ss}
10207 \gdefchar^^e0{\'r}
10208 \gdefchar^^e1{\'a}
10209 \gdefchar^^e2{\^a}
10210 \gdefchar^^e3{\u a}
10211 \gdefchar^^e4{\"a}
10212 \gdefchar^^e5{\'l}
10213 \gdefchar^^e6{\'c}
10214 \gdefchar^^e7{\cedilla c}
10215 \gdefchar^^e8{\v c}
10216 \gdefchar^^e9{\'e}
10217 \gdefchar^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
10218 \gdefchar^^eb{\"e}
10219 \gdefchar^^ec{\v e}
10220 \gdefchar^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
10221 \gdefchar^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
10222 \gdefchar^^ef{\v d}
10224 \gdefchar^^f0{\dh}
10225 \gdefchar^^f1{\'n}
10226 \gdefchar^^f2{\v n}
10227 \gdefchar^^f3{\'o}
10228 \gdefchar^^f4{\^o}
10229 \gdefchar^^f5{\H o}
10230 \gdefchar^^f6{\"o}
10231 \gdefchar^^f7{$\div$}
10232 \gdefchar^^f8{\v r}
10233 \gdefchar^^f9{\ringaccent u}
10234 \gdefchar^^fa{\'u}
10235 \gdefchar^^fb{\H u}
10236 \gdefchar^^fc{\"u}
10237 \gdefchar^^fd{\'y}
10238 \gdefchar^^fe{\cedilla t}
10239 \gdefchar^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
10242 % UTF-8 character definitions.
10244 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
10245 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
10246 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
10248 \newcount\countUTFx
10249 \newcount\countUTFy
10250 \newcount\countUTFz
10252 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
10253 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
10255 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
10256 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
10258 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
10259 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
10261 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
10262 \ifx #1\relax
10263 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
10264 \else
10265 \expandafter #1%
10269 % Give non-ASCII bytes the active definitions for processing UTF-8 sequences
10270 \begingroup
10271 \catcode`\~13
10272 \catcode`\$12
10273 \catcode`\"12
10275 % Loop from \countUTFx to \countUTFy, performing \UTFviiiTmp
10276 % substituting ~ and $ with a character token of that value.
10277 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
10278 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
10279 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
10280 \uccode`\$\countUTFx
10281 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
10282 \advance\countUTFx by 1
10283 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
10284 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
10285 \fi}
10287 % For bytes other than the first in a UTF-8 sequence. Not expected to
10288 % be expanded except when writing to auxiliary files.
10289 \countUTFx = "80
10290 \countUTFy = "C2
10291 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10292 \gdef~{%
10293 \ifpassthroughchars $\fi}}%
10294 \UTFviiiLoop
10296 \countUTFx = "C2
10297 \countUTFy = "E0
10298 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10299 \gdef~{%
10300 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10301 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiTwoOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
10302 \UTFviiiLoop
10304 \countUTFx = "E0
10305 \countUTFy = "F0
10306 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10307 \gdef~{%
10308 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10309 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiThreeOctets\expandafter$\fi}}%
10310 \UTFviiiLoop
10312 \countUTFx = "F0
10313 \countUTFy = "F4
10314 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
10315 \gdef~{%
10316 \ifpassthroughchars $%
10317 \else\expandafter\UTFviiiFourOctets\expandafter$\fi
10319 \UTFviiiLoop
10320 \endgroup
10322 \def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below
10324 % @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it.
10325 \def\U#1{%
10326 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax
10327 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
10328 % All Unicode characters can be used if native Unicode handling is
10329 % active. However, if the font does not have the glyph,
10330 % letters are missing.
10331 \begingroup
10332 \uccode`\.="#1\relax
10333 \uppercase{.}
10334 \endgroup
10335 \else
10336 \errhelp = \EMsimple
10337 \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}%
10339 \else
10340 \csname uni:#1\endcsname
10344 % These macros are used here to construct the name of a control
10345 % sequence to be defined.
10346 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName#1#2{%
10347 \csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}%
10348 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName#1#2#3{%
10349 \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}%
10350 \def\UTFviiiFourOctetsName#1#2#3#4{%
10351 \csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}%
10353 % For UTF-8 byte sequences (TeX, e-TeX and pdfTeX),
10354 % provide a definition macro to replace a Unicode character;
10355 % this gets used by the @U command
10357 \begingroup
10358 \catcode`\"=12
10359 \catcode`\<=12
10360 \catcode`\.=12
10361 \catcode`\,=12
10362 \catcode`\;=12
10363 \catcode`\!=12
10364 \catcode`\~=13
10365 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii#1#2{%
10366 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
10367 \begingroup
10368 \parseXMLCharref
10370 % Give \u8:... its definition. The sequence of seven \expandafter's
10371 % expands after the \gdef three times, e.g.
10373 % 1. \UTFviiTwoOctetsName B1 B2
10374 % 2. \csname u8:B1 \string B2 \endcsname
10375 % 3. \u8: B1 B2 (a single control sequence token)
10377 \expandafter\expandafter
10378 \expandafter\expandafter
10379 \expandafter\expandafter
10380 \expandafter\gdef \UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
10382 \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax \else
10383 \message{Internal error, already defined: #1}%
10386 % define an additional control sequence for this code point.
10387 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp
10388 \endgroup}
10390 % Given the value in \countUTFz as a Unicode code point, set \UTFviiiTmp
10391 % to the corresponding UTF-8 sequence.
10392 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
10393 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
10394 \errhelp = \EMsimple
10395 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
10396 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
10397 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10398 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctetsName.,%
10399 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
10400 \parseUTFviiiA;%
10401 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10402 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctetsName.{,;}%
10403 \else
10404 \parseUTFviiiA;%
10405 \parseUTFviiiA,%
10406 \parseUTFviiiA!%
10407 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctetsName.{!,;}%
10408 \fi\fi\fi
10411 % Extract a byte from the end of the UTF-8 representation of \countUTFx.
10412 % It must be a non-initial byte in the sequence.
10413 % Change \uccode of #1 for it to be used in \parseUTFviiiB as one
10414 % of the bytes.
10415 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
10416 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
10417 \divide\countUTFz by 64
10418 \countUTFy = \countUTFz % Save to be the future value of \countUTFz.
10419 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
10421 % \countUTFz is now \countUTFx with the last 5 bits cleared. Subtract
10422 % in order to get the last five bits.
10423 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
10425 % Convert this to the byte in the UTF-8 sequence.
10426 \advance\countUTFx by 128
10427 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
10428 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
10430 % Used to put a UTF-8 byte sequence into \UTFviiiTmp
10431 % #1 is the increment for \countUTFz to yield a the first byte of the UTF-8
10432 % sequence.
10433 % #2 is one of the \UTFviii*OctetsName macros.
10434 % #3 is always a full stop (.)
10435 % #4 is a template for the other bytes in the sequence. The values for these
10436 % bytes is substituted in here with \uppercase using the \uccode's.
10437 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
10438 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
10439 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
10440 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
10441 \endgroup
10443 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
10444 % provide a definition macro that sets a catcode to `other' non-globally
10446 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeOther#1#2{%
10447 \catcode"#1=\other
10450 % https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Plane_(Unicode)#Basic_M
10451 % U+0000..U+007F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Basic_Latin_(Unicode_block)
10452 % U+0080..U+00FF = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin-1_Supplement_(Unicode_block)
10453 % U+0100..U+017F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-A
10454 % U+0180..U+024F = https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Latin_Extended-B
10456 % Many of our renditions are less than wonderful, and all the missing
10457 % characters are available somewhere. Loading the necessary fonts
10458 % awaits user request. We can't truly support Unicode without
10459 % reimplementing everything that's been done in LaTeX for many years,
10460 % plus probably using luatex or xetex, and who knows what else.
10461 % We won't be doing that here in this simple file. But we can try to at
10462 % least make most of the characters not bomb out.
10464 \def\unicodechardefs{%
10465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}%
10466 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}%
10467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A2}{{\tcfont \char162}}% 0242=cent
10468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds{}}%
10469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A4}{{\tcfont \char164}}% 0244=currency
10470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A5}{{\tcfont \char165}}% 0245=yen
10471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A6}{{\tcfont \char166}}% 0246=brokenbar
10472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A7}{\S}%
10473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}%
10474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright{}}%
10475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}%
10476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft{}}%
10477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AC}{\ensuremath\lnot}%
10478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}%
10479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol{}}%
10480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}%
10482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}%
10483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B1}{\ensuremath\pm}%
10484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B2}{$^2$}%
10485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B3}{$^3$}%
10486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}%
10487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B5}{$\mu$}%
10488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B6}{\P}%
10489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B7}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
10490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}%
10491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B9}{$^1$}%
10492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}%
10493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright{}}%
10494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BC}{$1\over4$}%
10495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BD}{$1\over2$}%
10496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BE}{$3\over4$}%
10497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}%
10499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}%
10500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}%
10501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}%
10502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}%
10503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}%
10504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}%
10505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}%
10506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}%
10507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}%
10508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}%
10509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}%
10510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}%
10511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}%
10512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}%
10513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}%
10514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}%
10516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}%
10517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}%
10518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}%
10519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}%
10520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}%
10521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}%
10522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}%
10523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D7}{\ensuremath\times}%
10524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}%
10525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}%
10526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}%
10527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}%
10528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}%
10529 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}%
10530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}%
10531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}%
10533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}%
10534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}%
10535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}%
10536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}%
10537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}%
10538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}%
10539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}%
10540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}%
10541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}%
10542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}%
10543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}%
10544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}%
10545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}%
10546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}%
10547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}%
10548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}%
10550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}%
10551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}%
10552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}%
10553 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}%
10554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}%
10555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}%
10556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}%
10557 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F7}{\ensuremath\div}%
10558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}%
10559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}%
10560 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}%
10561 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}%
10562 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}%
10563 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}%
10564 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}%
10565 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}%
10567 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}%
10568 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}%
10569 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}%
10570 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}%
10571 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}%
10572 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}%
10573 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}%
10574 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}%
10575 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}%
10576 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}%
10577 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}%
10578 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}%
10579 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}%
10580 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}%
10581 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}%
10582 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010F}{d'}%
10584 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0110}{\DH}%
10585 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0111}{\dh}%
10586 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}%
10587 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}%
10588 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}%
10589 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}%
10590 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}%
10591 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}%
10592 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}%
10593 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}%
10594 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}%
10595 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}%
10596 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}%
10597 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}%
10598 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}%
10599 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}%
10601 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}%
10602 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}%
10603 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0122}{\cedilla{G}}%
10604 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0123}{\cedilla{g}}%
10605 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}%
10606 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}%
10607 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0126}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
10608 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0127}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
10609 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}%
10610 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}%
10611 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}%
10612 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}%
10613 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}%
10614 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}%
10615 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012E}{\ogonek{I}}%
10616 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012F}{\ogonek{i}}%
10618 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}%
10619 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}%
10620 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}%
10621 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}%
10622 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}%
10623 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}%
10624 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0136}{\cedilla{K}}%
10625 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0137}{\cedilla{k}}%
10626 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0138}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
10627 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}%
10628 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}%
10629 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013B}{\cedilla{L}}%
10630 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013C}{\cedilla{l}}%
10631 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013D}{L'}% should kern
10632 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013E}{l'}% should kern
10633 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013F}{L\U{00B7}}%
10635 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0140}{l\U{00B7}}%
10636 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}%
10637 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}%
10638 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}%
10639 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}%
10640 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0145}{\cedilla{N}}%
10641 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0146}{\cedilla{n}}%
10642 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}%
10643 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}%
10644 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0149}{'n}%
10645 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014A}{\missingcharmsg{ENG}}%
10646 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014B}{\missingcharmsg{eng}}%
10647 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}%
10648 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}%
10649 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}%
10650 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}%
10652 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}%
10653 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}%
10654 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}%
10655 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}%
10656 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}%
10657 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}%
10658 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0156}{\cedilla{R}}%
10659 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0157}{\cedilla{r}}%
10660 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}%
10661 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}%
10662 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}%
10663 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}%
10664 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}%
10665 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}%
10666 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}%
10667 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}%
10669 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}%
10670 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}%
10671 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{T}}%
10672 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{t}}%
10673 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}%
10674 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0165}{\v{t}}%
10675 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0166}{\missingcharmsg{H WITH STROKE}}%
10676 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0167}{\missingcharmsg{h WITH STROKE}}%
10677 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}%
10678 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}%
10679 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}%
10680 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}%
10681 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}%
10682 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}%
10683 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}%
10684 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}%
10686 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}%
10687 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}%
10688 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0172}{\ogonek{U}}%
10689 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0173}{\ogonek{u}}%
10690 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}%
10691 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}%
10692 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}%
10693 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}%
10694 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}%
10695 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}%
10696 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}%
10697 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}%
10698 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}%
10699 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}%
10700 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}%
10701 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017F}{\missingcharmsg{LONG S}}%
10703 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}%
10704 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}%
10705 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}%
10706 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}%
10707 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}%
10708 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}%
10709 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}%
10710 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}%
10711 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}%
10712 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}%
10713 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}%
10714 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}%
10716 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}%
10717 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}%
10718 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}%
10719 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}%
10720 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}%
10722 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}%
10723 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}%
10724 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}%
10725 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}%
10726 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}%
10727 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}%
10729 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}%
10730 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}%
10731 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}%
10732 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}%
10733 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}%
10734 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}%
10735 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}%
10736 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}%
10737 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}%
10738 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}%
10739 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}%
10740 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}%
10742 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}%
10743 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}%
10745 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}%
10746 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}%
10747 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}%
10748 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}%
10749 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}%
10750 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}%
10752 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}%
10753 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}%
10754 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}%
10756 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}%
10758 % Greek letters upper case
10759 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0391}{{\it A}}%
10760 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0392}{{\it B}}%
10761 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0393}{\ensuremath{\mit\Gamma}}%
10762 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0394}{\ensuremath{\mit\Delta}}%
10763 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0395}{{\it E}}%
10764 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0396}{{\it Z}}%
10765 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0397}{{\it H}}%
10766 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0398}{\ensuremath{\mit\Theta}}%
10767 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0399}{{\it I}}%
10768 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039A}{{\it K}}%
10769 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039B}{\ensuremath{\mit\Lambda}}%
10770 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039C}{{\it M}}%
10771 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039D}{{\it N}}%
10772 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039E}{\ensuremath{\mit\Xi}}%
10773 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{039F}{{\it O}}%
10774 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A0}{\ensuremath{\mit\Pi}}%
10775 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A1}{{\it P}}%
10776 %\DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A2}{} % none - corresponds to final sigma
10777 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A3}{\ensuremath{\mit\Sigma}}%
10778 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A4}{{\it T}}%
10779 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A5}{\ensuremath{\mit\Upsilon}}%
10780 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A6}{\ensuremath{\mit\Phi}}%
10781 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A7}{{\it X}}%
10782 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A8}{\ensuremath{\mit\Psi}}%
10783 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03A9}{\ensuremath{\mit\Omega}}%
10785 % Vowels with accents
10786 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0390}{\ensuremath{\ddot{\acute\iota}}}%
10787 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AC}{\ensuremath{\acute\alpha}}%
10788 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AD}{\ensuremath{\acute\epsilon}}%
10789 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AE}{\ensuremath{\acute\eta}}%
10790 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03AF}{\ensuremath{\acute\iota}}%
10791 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B0}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ddot\upsilon}}}%
10793 % Standalone accent
10794 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0384}{\ensuremath{\acute{\ }}}%
10796 % Greek letters lower case
10797 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B1}{\ensuremath\alpha}%
10798 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B2}{\ensuremath\beta}%
10799 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B3}{\ensuremath\gamma}%
10800 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B4}{\ensuremath\delta}%
10801 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B5}{\ensuremath\epsilon}%
10802 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B6}{\ensuremath\zeta}%
10803 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B7}{\ensuremath\eta}%
10804 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B8}{\ensuremath\theta}%
10805 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03B9}{\ensuremath\iota}%
10806 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BA}{\ensuremath\kappa}%
10807 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BB}{\ensuremath\lambda}%
10808 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BC}{\ensuremath\mu}%
10809 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BD}{\ensuremath\nu}%
10810 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BE}{\ensuremath\xi}%
10811 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03BF}{{\it o}}% omicron
10812 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C0}{\ensuremath\pi}%
10813 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C1}{\ensuremath\rho}%
10814 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C2}{\ensuremath\varsigma}%
10815 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C3}{\ensuremath\sigma}%
10816 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C4}{\ensuremath\tau}%
10817 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C5}{\ensuremath\upsilon}%
10818 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C6}{\ensuremath\phi}%
10819 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C7}{\ensuremath\chi}%
10820 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C8}{\ensuremath\psi}%
10821 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03C9}{\ensuremath\omega}%
10823 % More Greek vowels with accents
10824 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CA}{\ensuremath{\ddot\iota}}%
10825 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CB}{\ensuremath{\ddot\upsilon}}%
10826 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CC}{\ensuremath{\acute o}}%
10827 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CD}{\ensuremath{\acute\upsilon}}%
10828 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03CE}{\ensuremath{\acute\omega}}%
10830 % Variant Greek letters
10831 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D1}{\ensuremath\vartheta}%
10832 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03D6}{\ensuremath\varpi}%
10833 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{03F1}{\ensuremath\varrho}%
10835 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}%
10836 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}%
10837 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}%
10838 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}%
10839 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}%
10840 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}%
10841 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}%
10842 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}%
10843 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}%
10844 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}%
10845 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}%
10846 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}%
10848 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}%
10849 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}%
10851 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}%
10852 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}%
10853 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}%
10854 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}%
10855 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}%
10856 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}%
10857 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}%
10858 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}%
10860 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}%
10861 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}%
10862 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}%
10863 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}%
10864 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}%
10865 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}%
10866 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}%
10867 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}%
10868 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}%
10869 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}%
10870 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}%
10871 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}%
10873 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}%
10874 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}%
10875 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}%
10876 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}%
10877 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}%
10878 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}%
10879 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}%
10880 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}%
10881 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}%
10882 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}%
10884 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}%
10885 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}%
10886 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}%
10887 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}%
10888 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}%
10889 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}%
10890 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}%
10891 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}%
10892 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}%
10893 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}%
10895 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}%
10896 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}%
10897 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}%
10898 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}%
10899 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}%
10900 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}%
10901 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}%
10902 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}%
10903 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}%
10904 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}%
10906 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}%
10907 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}%
10908 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}%
10909 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}%
10911 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}%
10912 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}%
10913 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}%
10914 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}%
10915 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}%
10916 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}%
10917 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}%
10918 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}%
10919 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}%
10920 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}%
10921 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}%
10922 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}%
10923 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}%
10924 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}%
10925 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}%
10926 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}%
10928 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}%
10929 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}%
10930 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}%
10931 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}%
10932 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}%
10933 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}%
10934 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}%
10935 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}%
10936 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}%
10937 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}%
10939 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}%
10940 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}%
10942 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}%
10943 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}%
10944 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}%
10945 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}%
10947 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}%
10948 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}%
10949 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}%
10950 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}%
10952 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}%
10953 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}%
10955 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}%
10956 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}%
10957 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}%
10959 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}%
10960 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}%
10962 % Punctuation
10963 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}%
10964 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}%
10965 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft{}}%
10966 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright{}}%
10967 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase{}}%
10968 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft{}}%
10969 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright{}}%
10970 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase{}}%
10971 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2020}{\ensuremath\dagger}%
10972 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2021}{\ensuremath\ddagger}%
10973 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet{}}%
10974 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{202F}{\thinspace}%
10975 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots{}}%
10976 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft{}}%
10977 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright{}}%
10979 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro{}}%
10981 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion{}}%
10982 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result{}}%
10984 % Mathematical symbols
10985 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2200}{\ensuremath\forall}%
10986 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2203}{\ensuremath\exists}%
10987 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2208}{\ensuremath\in}%
10988 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus{}}%
10989 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\ast}%
10990 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221E}{\ensuremath\infty}%
10991 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2225}{\ensuremath\parallel}%
10992 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2227}{\ensuremath\wedge}%
10993 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2229}{\ensuremath\cap}%
10994 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv{}}%
10995 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2264}{\ensuremath\leq}%
10996 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2265}{\ensuremath\geq}%
10997 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2282}{\ensuremath\subset}%
10998 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2287}{\ensuremath\supseteq}%
11000 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2016}{\ensuremath\Vert}%
11001 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2032}{\ensuremath\prime}%
11002 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{210F}{\ensuremath\hbar}%
11003 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2111}{\ensuremath\Im}%
11004 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2113}{\ensuremath\ell}%
11005 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2118}{\ensuremath\wp}%
11006 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{211C}{\ensuremath\Re}%
11007 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2127}{\ensuremath\mho}%
11008 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2135}{\ensuremath\aleph}%
11009 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2190}{\ensuremath\leftarrow}%
11010 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2191}{\ensuremath\uparrow}%
11011 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2193}{\ensuremath\downarrow}%
11012 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2194}{\ensuremath\leftrightarrow}%
11013 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2195}{\ensuremath\updownarrow}%
11014 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2196}{\ensuremath\nwarrow}%
11015 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2197}{\ensuremath\nearrow}%
11016 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2198}{\ensuremath\searrow}%
11017 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2199}{\ensuremath\swarrow}%
11018 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A6}{\ensuremath\mapsto}%
11019 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21A9}{\ensuremath\hookleftarrow}%
11020 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21AA}{\ensuremath\hookrightarrow}%
11021 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BC}{\ensuremath\leftharpoonup}%
11022 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BD}{\ensuremath\leftharpoondown}%
11023 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21BE}{\ensuremath\upharpoonright}%
11024 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C0}{\ensuremath\rightharpoonup}%
11025 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21C1}{\ensuremath\rightharpoondown}%
11026 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21CC}{\ensuremath\rightleftharpoons}%
11027 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D0}{\ensuremath\Leftarrow}%
11028 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D1}{\ensuremath\Uparrow}%
11029 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D3}{\ensuremath\Downarrow}%
11030 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D4}{\ensuremath\Leftrightarrow}%
11031 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D5}{\ensuremath\Updownarrow}%
11032 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21DD}{\ensuremath\leadsto}%
11033 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2201}{\ensuremath\complement}%
11034 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2202}{\ensuremath\partial}%
11035 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2205}{\ensuremath\emptyset}%
11036 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2207}{\ensuremath\nabla}%
11037 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2209}{\ensuremath\notin}%
11038 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220B}{\ensuremath\owns}%
11039 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{220F}{\ensuremath\prod}%
11040 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2210}{\ensuremath\coprod}%
11041 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2211}{\ensuremath\sum}%
11042 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2213}{\ensuremath\mp}%
11043 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2218}{\ensuremath\circ}%
11044 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221A}{\ensuremath\surd}%
11045 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{221D}{\ensuremath\propto}%
11046 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2220}{\ensuremath\angle}%
11047 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2223}{\ensuremath\mid}%
11048 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2228}{\ensuremath\vee}%
11049 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222A}{\ensuremath\cup}%
11050 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222B}{\ensuremath\smallint}%
11051 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{222E}{\ensuremath\oint}%
11052 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{223C}{\ensuremath\sim}%
11053 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2240}{\ensuremath\wr}%
11054 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2243}{\ensuremath\simeq}%
11055 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2245}{\ensuremath\cong}%
11056 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2248}{\ensuremath\approx}%
11057 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{224D}{\ensuremath\asymp}%
11058 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2250}{\ensuremath\doteq}%
11059 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2260}{\ensuremath\neq}%
11060 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226A}{\ensuremath\ll}%
11061 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{226B}{\ensuremath\gg}%
11062 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227A}{\ensuremath\prec}%
11063 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{227B}{\ensuremath\succ}%
11064 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2283}{\ensuremath\supset}%
11065 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2286}{\ensuremath\subseteq}%
11066 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228E}{\ensuremath\uplus}%
11067 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{228F}{\ensuremath\sqsubset}%
11068 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2290}{\ensuremath\sqsupset}%
11069 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2291}{\ensuremath\sqsubseteq}%
11070 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2292}{\ensuremath\sqsupseteq}%
11071 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2293}{\ensuremath\sqcap}%
11072 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2294}{\ensuremath\sqcup}%
11073 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2295}{\ensuremath\oplus}%
11074 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2296}{\ensuremath\ominus}%
11075 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2297}{\ensuremath\otimes}%
11076 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2298}{\ensuremath\oslash}%
11077 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2299}{\ensuremath\odot}%
11078 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A2}{\ensuremath\vdash}%
11079 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A3}{\ensuremath\dashv}%
11080 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A4}{\ensuremath\ptextop}%
11081 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A5}{\ensuremath\bot}%
11082 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22A8}{\ensuremath\models}%
11083 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22B4}{\ensuremath\unlhd}%
11084 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22B5}{\ensuremath\unrhd}%
11085 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C0}{\ensuremath\bigwedge}%
11086 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C1}{\ensuremath\bigvee}%
11087 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C2}{\ensuremath\bigcap}%
11088 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C3}{\ensuremath\bigcup}%
11089 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C4}{\ensuremath\diamond}%
11090 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C5}{\ensuremath\cdot}%
11091 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C6}{\ensuremath\star}%
11092 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{22C8}{\ensuremath\bowtie}%
11093 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2308}{\ensuremath\lceil}%
11094 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2309}{\ensuremath\rceil}%
11095 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230A}{\ensuremath\lfloor}%
11096 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{230B}{\ensuremath\rfloor}%
11097 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2322}{\ensuremath\frown}%
11098 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2323}{\ensuremath\smile}%
11100 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25A1}{\ensuremath\Box}%
11101 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B3}{\ensuremath\triangle}%
11102 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25B7}{\ensuremath\triangleright}%
11103 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25BD}{\ensuremath\bigtriangledown}%
11104 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C1}{\ensuremath\triangleleft}%
11105 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{25C7}{\ensuremath\Diamond}%
11106 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2660}{\ensuremath\spadesuit}%
11107 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2661}{\ensuremath\heartsuit}%
11108 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2662}{\ensuremath\diamondsuit}%
11109 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2663}{\ensuremath\clubsuit}%
11110 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266D}{\ensuremath\flat}%
11111 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266E}{\ensuremath\natural}%
11112 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{266F}{\ensuremath\sharp}%
11113 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{26AA}{\ensuremath\bigcirc}%
11114 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27B9}{\ensuremath\rangle}%
11115 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27C2}{\ensuremath\perp}%
11116 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27E8}{\ensuremath\langle}%
11117 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F5}{\ensuremath\longleftarrow}%
11118 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F6}{\ensuremath\longrightarrow}%
11119 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27F7}{\ensuremath\longleftrightarrow}%
11120 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{27FC}{\ensuremath\longmapsto}%
11121 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{29F5}{\ensuremath\setminus}%
11122 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A00}{\ensuremath\bigodot}%
11123 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A01}{\ensuremath\bigoplus}%
11124 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A02}{\ensuremath\bigotimes}%
11125 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A04}{\ensuremath\biguplus}%
11126 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A06}{\ensuremath\bigsqcup}%
11127 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A1D}{\ensuremath\Join}%
11128 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2A3F}{\ensuremath\amalg}%
11129 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AAF}{\ensuremath\preceq}%
11130 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2AB0}{\ensuremath\succeq}%
11132 \global\mathchardef\checkmark="1370% actually the square root sign
11133 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2713}{\ensuremath\checkmark}%
11134 }% end of \unicodechardefs
11136 % UTF-8 byte sequence (pdfTeX) definitions (replacing and @U command)
11137 % It makes the setting that replace UTF-8 byte sequence.
11138 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
11139 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterUTFviii
11140 \unicodechardefs
11143 % Whether the active definitions of non-ASCII characters expand to
11144 % non-active tokens with the same character code. This is used to
11145 % write characters literally, instead of using active definitions for
11146 % printing the correct glyphs.
11147 \newif\ifpassthroughchars
11148 \passthroughcharsfalse
11150 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
11151 % provide a definition macro to replace/pass-through a Unicode character
11153 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative#1#2{%
11154 \catcode"#1=\active
11155 \def\dodeclareunicodecharacternative##1##2##3{%
11156 \begingroup
11157 \uccode`\~="##2\relax
11158 \uppercase{\gdef~}{%
11159 \ifpassthroughchars
11160 ##1%
11161 \else
11162 ##3%
11165 \endgroup
11167 \begingroup
11168 \uccode`\.="#1\relax
11169 \uppercase{\def\UTFNativeTmp{.}}%
11170 \expandafter\dodeclareunicodecharacternative\UTFNativeTmp{#1}{#2}%
11171 \endgroup
11174 % Native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX) character replacing definition.
11175 % It activates the setting that replaces Unicode characters.
11176 \def\nativeunicodechardefs{%
11177 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNative
11178 \unicodechardefs
11181 % For native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX),
11182 % make the character token expand
11183 % to the sequences given in \unicodechardefs for printing.
11184 \def\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU#1#2{%
11185 \def\UTFAtUTmp{#2}
11186 \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFAtUTmp
11189 % @U command definitions for native Unicode handling (XeTeX and LuaTeX).
11190 \def\nativeunicodechardefsatu{%
11191 \let\DeclareUnicodeCharacter\DeclareUnicodeCharacterNativeAtU
11192 \unicodechardefs
11195 % US-ASCII character definitions.
11196 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
11197 \relax
11200 % define all Unicode characters we know about, for the sake of @U.
11201 \iftxinativeunicodecapable
11202 \nativeunicodechardefsatu
11203 \else
11204 \utfeightchardefs
11208 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
11209 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
11210 % document encoding.
11212 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
11215 \message{formatting,}
11217 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
11219 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
11220 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
11221 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
11223 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
11224 \vbadness = 10000
11226 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
11227 \hbadness = 6666
11229 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
11230 \widowpenalty=10000
11231 \clubpenalty=10000
11233 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
11234 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
11235 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
11236 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
11238 \def\setemergencystretch{%
11239 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
11240 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
11241 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
11242 \else
11243 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
11247 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
11248 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
11249 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
11251 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
11252 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
11254 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
11255 \voffset = #3\relax
11256 \topskip = #6\relax
11257 \splittopskip = \topskip
11259 \vsize = #1\relax
11260 \advance\vsize by \topskip
11261 \outervsize = \vsize
11262 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
11263 \txipageheight = \vsize
11265 \hsize = #2\relax
11266 \outerhsize = \hsize
11267 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
11268 \txipagewidth = \hsize
11270 \normaloffset = #4\relax
11271 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
11273 \ifpdf
11274 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
11275 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
11276 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
11277 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
11278 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
11279 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
11280 \else
11281 \ifx\XeTeXrevision\thisisundefined
11282 \else
11283 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
11284 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
11285 % XeTeX does not have \pdfhorigin and \pdfvorigin.
11289 \setleading{\textleading}
11291 \parindent = \defaultparindent
11292 \setemergencystretch
11295 % @letterpaper (the default).
11296 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11297 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11298 \textleading = 13.2pt
11300 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
11301 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
11302 {\voffset}{.25in}%
11303 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
11304 {11in}{8.5in}%
11307 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
11308 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
11309 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
11310 \textleading = 12pt
11312 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
11313 {-.2in}{0in}%
11314 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
11315 {9.25in}{7in}%
11317 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
11318 \tolerance = 700
11319 \hfuzz = 1pt
11320 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11321 \defbodyindent = .5cm
11324 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
11325 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
11326 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
11327 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
11328 \textleading = 12pt
11330 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
11331 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
11332 {0pt}{14pt}%
11333 {9in}{6in}%
11335 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
11336 \tolerance = 700
11337 \hfuzz = 1pt
11338 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11339 \defbodyindent = .4cm
11342 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
11343 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11344 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11345 \textleading = 13.2pt
11347 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
11348 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
11349 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
11350 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
11351 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
11352 % your texinfo source file like this:
11353 % @tex
11354 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
11355 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
11356 % @end tex
11357 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
11358 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
11359 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
11360 {297mm}{210mm}%
11362 \tolerance = 700
11363 \hfuzz = 1pt
11364 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11365 \defbodyindent = 5mm
11368 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
11369 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
11370 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
11371 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
11372 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
11373 \textleading = 12.5pt
11375 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
11376 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
11377 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
11378 {210mm}{148mm}%
11380 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
11381 \tolerance = 800
11382 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
11383 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
11384 \defbodyindent = 2mm
11385 \tableindent = 12mm
11388 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
11389 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
11390 \afourpaper
11391 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
11392 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
11393 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
11394 {297mm}{210mm}%
11396 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
11397 \globaldefs = 0
11400 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
11401 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
11402 \afourpaper
11403 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
11404 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
11405 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
11406 {297mm}{210mm}%
11407 \globaldefs = 0
11410 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
11411 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
11412 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
11414 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
11415 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
11416 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
11417 \globaldefs = 1
11419 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
11420 \setleading{\textleading}%
11422 \dimen0 = #1\relax
11423 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
11425 \dimen2 = \hsize
11426 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
11428 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
11429 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
11430 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
11431 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
11434 % Set default to letter.
11436 \letterpaper
11439 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
11441 \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
11443 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
11444 \catcode`\^^? = 14
11446 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
11447 \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
11448 \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
11449 \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
11450 \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
11451 \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
11452 \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
11453 \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
11454 \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
11455 \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
11457 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
11458 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
11459 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
11461 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
11462 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
11463 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
11464 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
11466 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
11468 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
11469 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
11470 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
11471 % this is not a problem.
11472 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
11474 % Set catcodes for Texinfo file
11476 % Active characters for printing the wanted glyph.
11477 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
11478 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
11480 \catcode`\"=\active
11481 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
11482 \let"=\activedoublequote
11483 \catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
11484 \chardef\hatchar=`\^
11485 \catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hatchar}} \let^ = \activehat
11487 \catcode`\_=\active
11488 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
11489 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
11490 \let\realunder=_
11492 \catcode`\|=\active \def|{{\tt\char124}}
11494 \chardef \less=`\<
11495 \catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
11496 \chardef \gtr=`\>
11497 \catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
11498 \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
11499 \catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
11500 \catcode`\-=\active \let-=\normaldash
11503 % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
11504 % breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
11505 \def\texinfochars{%
11506 \let< = \activeless
11507 \let> = \activegtr
11508 \let~ = \activetilde
11509 \let^ = \activehat
11510 \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
11511 \let\b = \strong
11512 \let\i = \smartitalic
11513 % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
11516 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
11517 % parsing them.
11518 \def\turnoffactive{%
11519 \normalturnoffactive
11520 \otherbackslash
11523 \catcode`\@=0
11525 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
11526 % as in \char`\\.
11527 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
11528 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
11530 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
11531 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
11532 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
11534 % In Texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
11535 % in fixed width font.
11536 \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
11538 % Print a typewriter backslash. For math mode, we can't simply use
11539 % \backslashcurfont: the story here is that in math mode, the \char
11540 % of \backslashcurfont ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol
11541 % font (because \char in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex
11542 % sets \mathcode`\\="026E). Hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
11543 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
11544 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
11545 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
11547 @def@ttbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
11548 @let@backslashchar = @ttbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
11550 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
11551 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
11552 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
11553 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
11554 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
11556 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
11557 % the literal character `\'.
11559 {@catcode`- = @active
11560 @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
11561 @passthroughcharstrue
11562 @let-=@normaldash
11563 @let"=@normaldoublequote
11564 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
11565 @let+=@normalplus
11566 @let<=@normalless
11567 @let>=@normalgreater
11568 @let^=@normalcaret
11569 @let_=@normalunderscore
11570 @let|=@normalverticalbar
11571 @let~=@normaltilde
11572 @let\=@ttbackslash
11573 @markupsetuplqdefault
11574 @markupsetuprqdefault
11575 @unsepspaces
11579 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
11580 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
11581 % So turn them off again, and have @fixbackslash turn them back on.
11582 @catcode`+=@other @catcode`@_=@other
11584 % \enablebackslashhack - allow file to begin `\input texinfo'
11586 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
11587 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
11588 % a backslash.
11589 % If the file did not have a `\input texinfo', then it is turned off after
11590 % the first line; otherwise the first `\' in the file would cause an error.
11591 % This is used on the very last line of this file, texinfo.tex.
11592 % We also use @c to call @fixbackslash, in case ends of lines are hidden.
11594 @catcode`@^=7
11595 @catcode`@^^M=13@gdef@enablebackslashhack{%
11596 @global@let\ = @eatinput%
11597 @catcode`@^^M=13%
11598 @def@c{@fixbackslash@c}%
11599 % Definition for the newline at the end of this file.
11600 @def ^^M{@let^^M@secondlinenl}%
11601 % Definition for a newline in the main Texinfo file.
11602 @gdef @secondlinenl{@fixbackslash}%
11605 {@catcode`@^=7 @catcode`@^^M=13%
11606 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo#1^^M{@fixbackslash}}
11608 % Emergency active definition of newline, in case an active newline token
11609 % appears by mistake.
11610 {@catcode`@^=7 @catcode13=13%
11611 @gdef@enableemergencynewline{%
11612 @gdef^^M{%
11613 @par%
11614 %<warning: active newline>@par%
11618 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
11619 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @ttbackslash @fi
11620 @catcode13=5 % regular end of line
11621 @enableemergencynewline
11622 @let@c=@texinfoc
11623 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
11624 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
11625 @catcode`+=@active
11626 @catcode`@_=@active
11628 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
11629 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. This macro, @fixbackslash, gets
11630 % called at the beginning of every Texinfo file. Not opening texinfo.cnf
11631 % directly in this file, texinfo.tex, makes it possible to make a format
11632 % file for Texinfo.
11634 @openin 1 texinfo.cnf
11635 @ifeof 1 @else @input texinfo.cnf @fi
11636 @closein 1
11640 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
11641 @escapechar = `@@
11643 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
11644 % active definitions as the normal characters.
11645 @def@normaldot{.}
11646 @def@normalquest{?}
11647 @def@normalslash{/}
11649 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
11650 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
11651 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
11652 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
11653 @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
11655 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
11657 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
11658 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
11659 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
11660 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
11661 @catcode`@'=@active
11662 @catcode`@`=@active
11663 @markupsetuplqdefault
11664 @markupsetuprqdefault
11666 @c Local variables:
11667 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
11668 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message\\|emacs-page"
11669 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
11670 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
11671 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
11672 @c End:
11674 @c vim:sw=2:
11676 @enablebackslashhack